1 /* Reload pseudo regs into hard regs for insns that require hard regs.
2 Copyright (C) 1987, 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998,
3 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GCC.
7 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
8 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
9 Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
12 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
13 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
14 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
19 Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
26 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
30 #include "insn-config.h"
36 #include "basic-block.h"
46 /* This file contains the reload pass of the compiler, which is
47 run after register allocation has been done. It checks that
48 each insn is valid (operands required to be in registers really
49 are in registers of the proper class) and fixes up invalid ones
50 by copying values temporarily into registers for the insns
53 The results of register allocation are described by the vector
54 reg_renumber; the insns still contain pseudo regs, but reg_renumber
55 can be used to find which hard reg, if any, a pseudo reg is in.
57 The technique we always use is to free up a few hard regs that are
58 called ``reload regs'', and for each place where a pseudo reg
59 must be in a hard reg, copy it temporarily into one of the reload regs.
61 Reload regs are allocated locally for every instruction that needs
62 reloads. When there are pseudos which are allocated to a register that
63 has been chosen as a reload reg, such pseudos must be ``spilled''.
64 This means that they go to other hard regs, or to stack slots if no other
65 available hard regs can be found. Spilling can invalidate more
66 insns, requiring additional need for reloads, so we must keep checking
67 until the process stabilizes.
69 For machines with different classes of registers, we must keep track
70 of the register class needed for each reload, and make sure that
71 we allocate enough reload registers of each class.
73 The file reload.c contains the code that checks one insn for
74 validity and reports the reloads that it needs. This file
75 is in charge of scanning the entire rtl code, accumulating the
76 reload needs, spilling, assigning reload registers to use for
77 fixing up each insn, and generating the new insns to copy values
78 into the reload registers. */
80 #ifndef REGISTER_MOVE_COST
81 #define REGISTER_MOVE_COST(m, x, y) 2
85 #define LOCAL_REGNO(REGNO) 0
88 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains a REG rtx for the hard reg
89 into which reg N has been reloaded (perhaps for a previous insn). */
90 static rtx
*reg_last_reload_reg
;
92 /* Elt N nonzero if reg_last_reload_reg[N] has been set in this insn
93 for an output reload that stores into reg N. */
94 static char *reg_has_output_reload
;
96 /* Indicates which hard regs are reload-registers for an output reload
97 in the current insn. */
98 static HARD_REG_SET reg_is_output_reload
;
100 /* Element N is the constant value to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
101 or zero if pseudo reg N is not equivalent to a constant.
102 find_reloads looks at this in order to replace pseudo reg N
103 with the constant it stands for. */
104 rtx
*reg_equiv_constant
;
106 /* Element N is a memory location to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
107 prior to any register elimination (such as frame pointer to stack
108 pointer). Depending on whether or not it is a valid address, this value
109 is transferred to either reg_equiv_address or reg_equiv_mem. */
110 rtx
*reg_equiv_memory_loc
;
112 /* Element N is the address of stack slot to which pseudo reg N is equivalent.
113 This is used when the address is not valid as a memory address
114 (because its displacement is too big for the machine.) */
115 rtx
*reg_equiv_address
;
117 /* Element N is the memory slot to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
118 or zero if pseudo reg N is not equivalent to a memory slot. */
121 /* Widest width in which each pseudo reg is referred to (via subreg). */
122 static unsigned int *reg_max_ref_width
;
124 /* Element N is the list of insns that initialized reg N from its equivalent
125 constant or memory slot. */
126 static rtx
*reg_equiv_init
;
128 /* Vector to remember old contents of reg_renumber before spilling. */
129 static short *reg_old_renumber
;
131 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains the last pseudo regno reloaded
132 into hard register N. If that pseudo reg occupied more than one register,
133 reg_reloaded_contents points to that pseudo for each spill register in
134 use; all of these must remain set for an inheritance to occur. */
135 static int reg_reloaded_contents
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
137 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains the insn for which
138 hard register N was last used. Its contents are significant only
139 when reg_reloaded_valid is set for this register. */
140 static rtx reg_reloaded_insn
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
142 /* Indicate if reg_reloaded_insn / reg_reloaded_contents is valid */
143 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_valid
;
144 /* Indicate if the register was dead at the end of the reload.
145 This is only valid if reg_reloaded_contents is set and valid. */
146 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_dead
;
148 /* Number of spill-regs so far; number of valid elements of spill_regs. */
151 /* In parallel with spill_regs, contains REG rtx's for those regs.
152 Holds the last rtx used for any given reg, or 0 if it has never
153 been used for spilling yet. This rtx is reused, provided it has
155 static rtx spill_reg_rtx
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
157 /* In parallel with spill_regs, contains nonzero for a spill reg
158 that was stored after the last time it was used.
159 The precise value is the insn generated to do the store. */
160 static rtx spill_reg_store
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
162 /* This is the register that was stored with spill_reg_store. This is a
163 copy of reload_out / reload_out_reg when the value was stored; if
164 reload_out is a MEM, spill_reg_stored_to will be set to reload_out_reg. */
165 static rtx spill_reg_stored_to
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
167 /* This table is the inverse mapping of spill_regs:
168 indexed by hard reg number,
169 it contains the position of that reg in spill_regs,
170 or -1 for something that is not in spill_regs.
172 ?!? This is no longer accurate. */
173 static short spill_reg_order
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
175 /* This reg set indicates registers that can't be used as spill registers for
176 the currently processed insn. These are the hard registers which are live
177 during the insn, but not allocated to pseudos, as well as fixed
179 static HARD_REG_SET bad_spill_regs
;
181 /* These are the hard registers that can't be used as spill register for any
182 insn. This includes registers used for user variables and registers that
183 we can't eliminate. A register that appears in this set also can't be used
184 to retry register allocation. */
185 static HARD_REG_SET bad_spill_regs_global
;
187 /* Describes order of use of registers for reloading
188 of spilled pseudo-registers. `n_spills' is the number of
189 elements that are actually valid; new ones are added at the end.
191 Both spill_regs and spill_reg_order are used on two occasions:
192 once during find_reload_regs, where they keep track of the spill registers
193 for a single insn, but also during reload_as_needed where they show all
194 the registers ever used by reload. For the latter case, the information
195 is calculated during finish_spills. */
196 static short spill_regs
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
198 /* This vector of reg sets indicates, for each pseudo, which hard registers
199 may not be used for retrying global allocation because the register was
200 formerly spilled from one of them. If we allowed reallocating a pseudo to
201 a register that it was already allocated to, reload might not
203 static HARD_REG_SET
*pseudo_previous_regs
;
205 /* This vector of reg sets indicates, for each pseudo, which hard
206 registers may not be used for retrying global allocation because they
207 are used as spill registers during one of the insns in which the
209 static HARD_REG_SET
*pseudo_forbidden_regs
;
211 /* All hard regs that have been used as spill registers for any insn are
212 marked in this set. */
213 static HARD_REG_SET used_spill_regs
;
215 /* Index of last register assigned as a spill register. We allocate in
216 a round-robin fashion. */
217 static int last_spill_reg
;
219 /* Nonzero if indirect addressing is supported on the machine; this means
220 that spilling (REG n) does not require reloading it into a register in
221 order to do (MEM (REG n)) or (MEM (PLUS (REG n) (CONST_INT c))). The
222 value indicates the level of indirect addressing supported, e.g., two
223 means that (MEM (MEM (REG n))) is also valid if (REG n) does not get
225 static char spill_indirect_levels
;
227 /* Nonzero if indirect addressing is supported when the innermost MEM is
228 of the form (MEM (SYMBOL_REF sym)). It is assumed that the level to
229 which these are valid is the same as spill_indirect_levels, above. */
230 char indirect_symref_ok
;
232 /* Nonzero if an address (plus (reg frame_pointer) (reg ...)) is valid. */
233 char double_reg_address_ok
;
235 /* Record the stack slot for each spilled hard register. */
236 static rtx spill_stack_slot
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
238 /* Width allocated so far for that stack slot. */
239 static unsigned int spill_stack_slot_width
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
241 /* Record which pseudos needed to be spilled. */
242 static regset_head spilled_pseudos
;
244 /* Used for communication between order_regs_for_reload and count_pseudo.
245 Used to avoid counting one pseudo twice. */
246 static regset_head pseudos_counted
;
248 /* First uid used by insns created by reload in this function.
249 Used in find_equiv_reg. */
250 int reload_first_uid
;
252 /* Flag set by local-alloc or global-alloc if anything is live in
253 a call-clobbered reg across calls. */
254 int caller_save_needed
;
256 /* Set to 1 while reload_as_needed is operating.
257 Required by some machines to handle any generated moves differently. */
258 int reload_in_progress
= 0;
260 /* These arrays record the insn_code of insns that may be needed to
261 perform input and output reloads of special objects. They provide a
262 place to pass a scratch register. */
263 enum insn_code reload_in_optab
[NUM_MACHINE_MODES
];
264 enum insn_code reload_out_optab
[NUM_MACHINE_MODES
];
266 /* This obstack is used for allocation of rtl during register elimination.
267 The allocated storage can be freed once find_reloads has processed the
269 struct obstack reload_obstack
;
271 /* Points to the beginning of the reload_obstack. All insn_chain structures
272 are allocated first. */
273 char *reload_startobj
;
275 /* The point after all insn_chain structures. Used to quickly deallocate
276 memory allocated in copy_reloads during calculate_needs_all_insns. */
277 char *reload_firstobj
;
279 /* This points before all local rtl generated by register elimination.
280 Used to quickly free all memory after processing one insn. */
281 static char *reload_insn_firstobj
;
283 #define obstack_chunk_alloc xmalloc
284 #define obstack_chunk_free free
286 /* List of insn_chain instructions, one for every insn that reload needs to
288 struct insn_chain
*reload_insn_chain
;
291 extern tree current_function_decl
;
293 extern union tree_node
*current_function_decl
;
296 /* List of all insns needing reloads. */
297 static struct insn_chain
*insns_need_reload
;
299 /* This structure is used to record information about register eliminations.
300 Each array entry describes one possible way of eliminating a register
301 in favor of another. If there is more than one way of eliminating a
302 particular register, the most preferred should be specified first. */
306 int from
; /* Register number to be eliminated. */
307 int to
; /* Register number used as replacement. */
308 int initial_offset
; /* Initial difference between values. */
309 int can_eliminate
; /* Non-zero if this elimination can be done. */
310 int can_eliminate_previous
; /* Value of CAN_ELIMINATE in previous scan over
311 insns made by reload. */
312 int offset
; /* Current offset between the two regs. */
313 int previous_offset
; /* Offset at end of previous insn. */
314 int ref_outside_mem
; /* "to" has been referenced outside a MEM. */
315 rtx from_rtx
; /* REG rtx for the register to be eliminated.
316 We cannot simply compare the number since
317 we might then spuriously replace a hard
318 register corresponding to a pseudo
319 assigned to the reg to be eliminated. */
320 rtx to_rtx
; /* REG rtx for the replacement. */
323 static struct elim_table
*reg_eliminate
= 0;
325 /* This is an intermediate structure to initialize the table. It has
326 exactly the members provided by ELIMINABLE_REGS. */
327 static const struct elim_table_1
331 } reg_eliminate_1
[] =
333 /* If a set of eliminable registers was specified, define the table from it.
334 Otherwise, default to the normal case of the frame pointer being
335 replaced by the stack pointer. */
337 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
340 {{ FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
}};
343 #define NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS ARRAY_SIZE (reg_eliminate_1)
345 /* Record the number of pending eliminations that have an offset not equal
346 to their initial offset. If non-zero, we use a new copy of each
347 replacement result in any insns encountered. */
348 int num_not_at_initial_offset
;
350 /* Count the number of registers that we may be able to eliminate. */
351 static int num_eliminable
;
352 /* And the number of registers that are equivalent to a constant that
353 can be eliminated to frame_pointer / arg_pointer + constant. */
354 static int num_eliminable_invariants
;
356 /* For each label, we record the offset of each elimination. If we reach
357 a label by more than one path and an offset differs, we cannot do the
358 elimination. This information is indexed by the number of the label.
359 The first table is an array of flags that records whether we have yet
360 encountered a label and the second table is an array of arrays, one
361 entry in the latter array for each elimination. */
363 static char *offsets_known_at
;
364 static int (*offsets_at
)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
];
366 /* Number of labels in the current function. */
368 static int num_labels
;
370 static void replace_pseudos_in_call_usage
PARAMS ((rtx
*,
373 static void maybe_fix_stack_asms
PARAMS ((void));
374 static void copy_reloads
PARAMS ((struct insn_chain
*));
375 static void calculate_needs_all_insns
PARAMS ((int));
376 static int find_reg
PARAMS ((struct insn_chain
*, int));
377 static void find_reload_regs
PARAMS ((struct insn_chain
*));
378 static void select_reload_regs
PARAMS ((void));
379 static void delete_caller_save_insns
PARAMS ((void));
381 static void spill_failure
PARAMS ((rtx
, enum reg_class
));
382 static void count_spilled_pseudo
PARAMS ((int, int, int));
383 static void delete_dead_insn
PARAMS ((rtx
));
384 static void alter_reg
PARAMS ((int, int));
385 static void set_label_offsets
PARAMS ((rtx
, rtx
, int));
386 static void check_eliminable_occurrences
PARAMS ((rtx
));
387 static void elimination_effects
PARAMS ((rtx
, enum machine_mode
));
388 static int eliminate_regs_in_insn
PARAMS ((rtx
, int));
389 static void update_eliminable_offsets
PARAMS ((void));
390 static void mark_not_eliminable
PARAMS ((rtx
, rtx
, void *));
391 static void set_initial_elim_offsets
PARAMS ((void));
392 static void verify_initial_elim_offsets
PARAMS ((void));
393 static void set_initial_label_offsets
PARAMS ((void));
394 static void set_offsets_for_label
PARAMS ((rtx
));
395 static void init_elim_table
PARAMS ((void));
396 static void update_eliminables
PARAMS ((HARD_REG_SET
*));
397 static void spill_hard_reg
PARAMS ((unsigned int, int));
398 static int finish_spills
PARAMS ((int));
399 static void ior_hard_reg_set
PARAMS ((HARD_REG_SET
*, HARD_REG_SET
*));
400 static void scan_paradoxical_subregs
PARAMS ((rtx
));
401 static void count_pseudo
PARAMS ((int));
402 static void order_regs_for_reload
PARAMS ((struct insn_chain
*));
403 static void reload_as_needed
PARAMS ((int));
404 static void forget_old_reloads_1
PARAMS ((rtx
, rtx
, void *));
405 static int reload_reg_class_lower
PARAMS ((const PTR
, const PTR
));
406 static void mark_reload_reg_in_use
PARAMS ((unsigned int, int,
409 static void clear_reload_reg_in_use
PARAMS ((unsigned int, int,
412 static int reload_reg_free_p
PARAMS ((unsigned int, int,
414 static int reload_reg_free_for_value_p
PARAMS ((int, int, int,
416 rtx
, rtx
, int, int));
417 static int free_for_value_p
PARAMS ((int, enum machine_mode
, int,
418 enum reload_type
, rtx
, rtx
,
420 static int reload_reg_reaches_end_p
PARAMS ((unsigned int, int,
422 static int allocate_reload_reg
PARAMS ((struct insn_chain
*, int,
424 static int conflicts_with_override
PARAMS ((rtx
));
425 static void failed_reload
PARAMS ((rtx
, int));
426 static int set_reload_reg
PARAMS ((int, int));
427 static void choose_reload_regs_init
PARAMS ((struct insn_chain
*, rtx
*));
428 static void choose_reload_regs
PARAMS ((struct insn_chain
*));
429 static void merge_assigned_reloads
PARAMS ((rtx
));
430 static void emit_input_reload_insns
PARAMS ((struct insn_chain
*,
431 struct reload
*, rtx
, int));
432 static void emit_output_reload_insns
PARAMS ((struct insn_chain
*,
433 struct reload
*, int));
434 static void do_input_reload
PARAMS ((struct insn_chain
*,
435 struct reload
*, int));
436 static void do_output_reload
PARAMS ((struct insn_chain
*,
437 struct reload
*, int));
438 static void emit_reload_insns
PARAMS ((struct insn_chain
*));
439 static void delete_output_reload
PARAMS ((rtx
, int, int));
440 static void delete_address_reloads
PARAMS ((rtx
, rtx
));
441 static void delete_address_reloads_1
PARAMS ((rtx
, rtx
, rtx
));
442 static rtx inc_for_reload
PARAMS ((rtx
, rtx
, rtx
, int));
443 static int constraint_accepts_reg_p
PARAMS ((const char *, rtx
));
444 static void reload_cse_regs_1
PARAMS ((rtx
));
445 static int reload_cse_noop_set_p
PARAMS ((rtx
));
446 static int reload_cse_simplify_set
PARAMS ((rtx
, rtx
));
447 static int reload_cse_simplify_operands
PARAMS ((rtx
));
448 static void reload_combine
PARAMS ((void));
449 static void reload_combine_note_use
PARAMS ((rtx
*, rtx
));
450 static void reload_combine_note_store
PARAMS ((rtx
, rtx
, void *));
451 static void reload_cse_move2add
PARAMS ((rtx
));
452 static void move2add_note_store
PARAMS ((rtx
, rtx
, void *));
454 static void add_auto_inc_notes
PARAMS ((rtx
, rtx
));
456 static void copy_eh_notes
PARAMS ((rtx
, rtx
));
457 static HOST_WIDE_INT sext_for_mode
PARAMS ((enum machine_mode
,
459 static void failed_reload
PARAMS ((rtx
, int));
460 static int set_reload_reg
PARAMS ((int, int));
461 static void reload_cse_delete_noop_set
PARAMS ((rtx
, rtx
));
462 static void reload_cse_simplify
PARAMS ((rtx
));
463 void fixup_abnormal_edges
PARAMS ((void));
464 extern void dump_needs
PARAMS ((struct insn_chain
*));
466 /* Initialize the reload pass once per compilation. */
473 /* Often (MEM (REG n)) is still valid even if (REG n) is put on the stack.
474 Set spill_indirect_levels to the number of levels such addressing is
475 permitted, zero if it is not permitted at all. */
478 = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode
,
481 LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
+ 1),
483 spill_indirect_levels
= 0;
485 while (memory_address_p (QImode
, tem
))
487 spill_indirect_levels
++;
488 tem
= gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode
, tem
);
491 /* See if indirect addressing is valid for (MEM (SYMBOL_REF ...)). */
493 tem
= gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode
, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode
, "foo"));
494 indirect_symref_ok
= memory_address_p (QImode
, tem
);
496 /* See if reg+reg is a valid (and offsettable) address. */
498 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
500 tem
= gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode
,
501 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode
, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
),
502 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode
, i
));
504 /* This way, we make sure that reg+reg is an offsettable address. */
505 tem
= plus_constant (tem
, 4);
507 if (memory_address_p (QImode
, tem
))
509 double_reg_address_ok
= 1;
514 /* Initialize obstack for our rtl allocation. */
515 gcc_obstack_init (&reload_obstack
);
516 reload_startobj
= (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack
, 0);
518 INIT_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos
);
519 INIT_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted
);
522 /* List of insn chains that are currently unused. */
523 static struct insn_chain
*unused_insn_chains
= 0;
525 /* Allocate an empty insn_chain structure. */
529 struct insn_chain
*c
;
531 if (unused_insn_chains
== 0)
533 c
= (struct insn_chain
*)
534 obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack
, sizeof (struct insn_chain
));
535 INIT_REG_SET (&c
->live_throughout
);
536 INIT_REG_SET (&c
->dead_or_set
);
540 c
= unused_insn_chains
;
541 unused_insn_chains
= c
->next
;
543 c
->is_caller_save_insn
= 0;
544 c
->need_operand_change
= 0;
550 /* Small utility function to set all regs in hard reg set TO which are
551 allocated to pseudos in regset FROM. */
554 compute_use_by_pseudos (to
, from
)
560 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
561 (from
, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
, regno
,
563 int r
= reg_renumber
[regno
];
568 /* reload_combine uses the information from
569 BASIC_BLOCK->global_live_at_start, which might still
570 contain registers that have not actually been allocated
571 since they have an equivalence. */
572 if (! reload_completed
)
577 nregs
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (r
, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (regno
));
579 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*to
, r
+ nregs
);
584 /* Replace all pseudos found in LOC with their corresponding
588 replace_pseudos_in_call_usage (loc
, mem_mode
, usage
)
590 enum machine_mode mem_mode
;
604 unsigned int regno
= REGNO (x
);
606 if (regno
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
609 x
= eliminate_regs (x
, mem_mode
, usage
);
613 replace_pseudos_in_call_usage (loc
, mem_mode
, usage
);
617 if (reg_equiv_constant
[regno
])
618 *loc
= reg_equiv_constant
[regno
];
619 else if (reg_equiv_mem
[regno
])
620 *loc
= reg_equiv_mem
[regno
];
621 else if (reg_equiv_address
[regno
])
622 *loc
= gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (x
), reg_equiv_address
[regno
]);
623 else if (GET_CODE (regno_reg_rtx
[regno
]) != REG
624 || REGNO (regno_reg_rtx
[regno
]) != regno
)
625 *loc
= regno_reg_rtx
[regno
];
631 else if (code
== MEM
)
633 replace_pseudos_in_call_usage (& XEXP (x
, 0), GET_MODE (x
), usage
);
637 /* Process each of our operands recursively. */
638 fmt
= GET_RTX_FORMAT (code
);
639 for (i
= 0; i
< GET_RTX_LENGTH (code
); i
++, fmt
++)
641 replace_pseudos_in_call_usage (&XEXP (x
, i
), mem_mode
, usage
);
642 else if (*fmt
== 'E')
643 for (j
= 0; j
< XVECLEN (x
, i
); j
++)
644 replace_pseudos_in_call_usage (& XVECEXP (x
, i
, j
), mem_mode
, usage
);
648 /* Global variables used by reload and its subroutines. */
650 /* Set during calculate_needs if an insn needs register elimination. */
651 static int something_needs_elimination
;
652 /* Set during calculate_needs if an insn needs an operand changed. */
653 int something_needs_operands_changed
;
655 /* Nonzero means we couldn't get enough spill regs. */
658 /* Main entry point for the reload pass.
660 FIRST is the first insn of the function being compiled.
662 GLOBAL nonzero means we were called from global_alloc
663 and should attempt to reallocate any pseudoregs that we
664 displace from hard regs we will use for reloads.
665 If GLOBAL is zero, we do not have enough information to do that,
666 so any pseudo reg that is spilled must go to the stack.
668 Return value is nonzero if reload failed
669 and we must not do any more for this function. */
672 reload (first
, global
)
678 struct elim_table
*ep
;
681 /* The two pointers used to track the true location of the memory used
682 for label offsets. */
683 char *real_known_ptr
= NULL
;
684 int (*real_at_ptr
)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
];
686 /* Make sure even insns with volatile mem refs are recognizable. */
691 reload_firstobj
= (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack
, 0);
693 /* Make sure that the last insn in the chain
694 is not something that needs reloading. */
695 emit_note (NULL
, NOTE_INSN_DELETED
);
697 /* Enable find_equiv_reg to distinguish insns made by reload. */
698 reload_first_uid
= get_max_uid ();
700 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
701 /* Initialize the secondary memory table. */
702 clear_secondary_mem ();
705 /* We don't have a stack slot for any spill reg yet. */
706 memset ((char *) spill_stack_slot
, 0, sizeof spill_stack_slot
);
707 memset ((char *) spill_stack_slot_width
, 0, sizeof spill_stack_slot_width
);
709 /* Initialize the save area information for caller-save, in case some
713 /* Compute which hard registers are now in use
714 as homes for pseudo registers.
715 This is done here rather than (eg) in global_alloc
716 because this point is reached even if not optimizing. */
717 for (i
= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
< max_regno
; i
++)
720 /* A function that receives a nonlocal goto must save all call-saved
722 if (current_function_has_nonlocal_label
)
723 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
724 if (! call_used_regs
[i
] && ! fixed_regs
[i
] && ! LOCAL_REGNO (i
))
725 regs_ever_live
[i
] = 1;
727 /* Find all the pseudo registers that didn't get hard regs
728 but do have known equivalent constants or memory slots.
729 These include parameters (known equivalent to parameter slots)
730 and cse'd or loop-moved constant memory addresses.
732 Record constant equivalents in reg_equiv_constant
733 so they will be substituted by find_reloads.
734 Record memory equivalents in reg_mem_equiv so they can
735 be substituted eventually by altering the REG-rtx's. */
737 reg_equiv_constant
= (rtx
*) xcalloc (max_regno
, sizeof (rtx
));
738 reg_equiv_mem
= (rtx
*) xcalloc (max_regno
, sizeof (rtx
));
739 reg_equiv_init
= (rtx
*) xcalloc (max_regno
, sizeof (rtx
));
740 reg_equiv_address
= (rtx
*) xcalloc (max_regno
, sizeof (rtx
));
741 reg_max_ref_width
= (unsigned int *) xcalloc (max_regno
, sizeof (int));
742 reg_old_renumber
= (short *) xcalloc (max_regno
, sizeof (short));
743 memcpy (reg_old_renumber
, reg_renumber
, max_regno
* sizeof (short));
744 pseudo_forbidden_regs
745 = (HARD_REG_SET
*) xmalloc (max_regno
* sizeof (HARD_REG_SET
));
747 = (HARD_REG_SET
*) xcalloc (max_regno
, sizeof (HARD_REG_SET
));
749 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs_global
);
751 /* Look for REG_EQUIV notes; record what each pseudo is equivalent to.
752 Also find all paradoxical subregs and find largest such for each pseudo.
753 On machines with small register classes, record hard registers that
754 are used for user variables. These can never be used for spills.
755 Also look for a "constant" REG_SETJMP. This means that all
756 caller-saved registers must be marked live. */
758 num_eliminable_invariants
= 0;
759 for (insn
= first
; insn
; insn
= NEXT_INSN (insn
))
761 rtx set
= single_set (insn
);
763 /* We may introduce USEs that we want to remove at the end, so
764 we'll mark them with QImode. Make sure there are no
765 previously-marked insns left by say regmove. */
766 if (INSN_P (insn
) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn
)) == USE
767 && GET_MODE (insn
) != VOIDmode
)
768 PUT_MODE (insn
, VOIDmode
);
770 if (GET_CODE (insn
) == CALL_INSN
771 && find_reg_note (insn
, REG_SETJMP
, NULL
))
772 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
773 if (! call_used_regs
[i
])
774 regs_ever_live
[i
] = 1;
776 if (set
!= 0 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set
)) == REG
)
778 rtx note
= find_reg_note (insn
, REG_EQUIV
, NULL_RTX
);
780 #ifdef LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P
781 && (! function_invariant_p (XEXP (note
, 0))
783 /* A function invariant is often CONSTANT_P but may
784 include a register. We promise to only pass
785 CONSTANT_P objects to LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P. */
786 || (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (note
, 0))
787 && LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (XEXP (note
, 0))))
791 rtx x
= XEXP (note
, 0);
792 i
= REGNO (SET_DEST (set
));
793 if (i
> LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
)
795 /* It can happen that a REG_EQUIV note contains a MEM
796 that is not a legitimate memory operand. As later
797 stages of reload assume that all addresses found
798 in the reg_equiv_* arrays were originally legitimate,
799 we ignore such REG_EQUIV notes. */
800 if (memory_operand (x
, VOIDmode
))
802 /* Always unshare the equivalence, so we can
803 substitute into this insn without touching the
805 reg_equiv_memory_loc
[i
] = copy_rtx (x
);
807 else if (function_invariant_p (x
))
809 if (GET_CODE (x
) == PLUS
)
811 /* This is PLUS of frame pointer and a constant,
812 and might be shared. Unshare it. */
813 reg_equiv_constant
[i
] = copy_rtx (x
);
814 num_eliminable_invariants
++;
816 else if (x
== frame_pointer_rtx
817 || x
== arg_pointer_rtx
)
819 reg_equiv_constant
[i
] = x
;
820 num_eliminable_invariants
++;
822 else if (LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x
))
823 reg_equiv_constant
[i
] = x
;
825 reg_equiv_memory_loc
[i
]
826 = force_const_mem (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set
)), x
);
831 /* If this register is being made equivalent to a MEM
832 and the MEM is not SET_SRC, the equivalencing insn
833 is one with the MEM as a SET_DEST and it occurs later.
834 So don't mark this insn now. */
835 if (GET_CODE (x
) != MEM
836 || rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (set
), x
))
838 = gen_rtx_INSN_LIST (VOIDmode
, insn
, reg_equiv_init
[i
]);
843 /* If this insn is setting a MEM from a register equivalent to it,
844 this is the equivalencing insn. */
845 else if (set
&& GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set
)) == MEM
846 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set
)) == REG
847 && reg_equiv_memory_loc
[REGNO (SET_SRC (set
))]
848 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (set
),
849 reg_equiv_memory_loc
[REGNO (SET_SRC (set
))]))
850 reg_equiv_init
[REGNO (SET_SRC (set
))]
851 = gen_rtx_INSN_LIST (VOIDmode
, insn
,
852 reg_equiv_init
[REGNO (SET_SRC (set
))]);
855 scan_paradoxical_subregs (PATTERN (insn
));
860 num_labels
= max_label_num () - get_first_label_num ();
862 /* Allocate the tables used to store offset information at labels. */
863 /* We used to use alloca here, but the size of what it would try to
864 allocate would occasionally cause it to exceed the stack limit and
865 cause a core dump. */
866 real_known_ptr
= xmalloc (num_labels
);
868 = (int (*)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
])
869 xmalloc (num_labels
* NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
* sizeof (int));
871 offsets_known_at
= real_known_ptr
- get_first_label_num ();
873 = (int (*)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]) (real_at_ptr
- get_first_label_num ());
875 /* Alter each pseudo-reg rtx to contain its hard reg number.
876 Assign stack slots to the pseudos that lack hard regs or equivalents.
877 Do not touch virtual registers. */
879 for (i
= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
+ 1; i
< max_regno
; i
++)
882 /* If we have some registers we think can be eliminated, scan all insns to
883 see if there is an insn that sets one of these registers to something
884 other than itself plus a constant. If so, the register cannot be
885 eliminated. Doing this scan here eliminates an extra pass through the
886 main reload loop in the most common case where register elimination
888 for (insn
= first
; insn
&& num_eliminable
; insn
= NEXT_INSN (insn
))
889 if (GET_CODE (insn
) == INSN
|| GET_CODE (insn
) == JUMP_INSN
890 || GET_CODE (insn
) == CALL_INSN
)
891 note_stores (PATTERN (insn
), mark_not_eliminable
, NULL
);
893 maybe_fix_stack_asms ();
895 insns_need_reload
= 0;
896 something_needs_elimination
= 0;
898 /* Initialize to -1, which means take the first spill register. */
901 /* Spill any hard regs that we know we can't eliminate. */
902 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs
);
903 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++)
904 if (! ep
->can_eliminate
)
905 spill_hard_reg (ep
->from
, 1);
907 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
908 if (frame_pointer_needed
)
909 spill_hard_reg (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
, 1);
911 finish_spills (global
);
913 /* From now on, we may need to generate moves differently. We may also
914 allow modifications of insns which cause them to not be recognized.
915 Any such modifications will be cleaned up during reload itself. */
916 reload_in_progress
= 1;
918 /* This loop scans the entire function each go-round
919 and repeats until one repetition spills no additional hard regs. */
922 int something_changed
;
925 HOST_WIDE_INT starting_frame_size
;
927 /* Round size of stack frame to stack_alignment_needed. This must be done
928 here because the stack size may be a part of the offset computation
929 for register elimination, and there might have been new stack slots
930 created in the last iteration of this loop. */
931 if (cfun
->stack_alignment_needed
)
932 assign_stack_local (BLKmode
, 0, cfun
->stack_alignment_needed
);
934 starting_frame_size
= get_frame_size ();
936 set_initial_elim_offsets ();
937 set_initial_label_offsets ();
939 /* For each pseudo register that has an equivalent location defined,
940 try to eliminate any eliminable registers (such as the frame pointer)
941 assuming initial offsets for the replacement register, which
944 If the resulting location is directly addressable, substitute
945 the MEM we just got directly for the old REG.
947 If it is not addressable but is a constant or the sum of a hard reg
948 and constant, it is probably not addressable because the constant is
949 out of range, in that case record the address; we will generate
950 hairy code to compute the address in a register each time it is
951 needed. Similarly if it is a hard register, but one that is not
952 valid as an address register.
954 If the location is not addressable, but does not have one of the
955 above forms, assign a stack slot. We have to do this to avoid the
956 potential of producing lots of reloads if, e.g., a location involves
957 a pseudo that didn't get a hard register and has an equivalent memory
958 location that also involves a pseudo that didn't get a hard register.
960 Perhaps at some point we will improve reload_when_needed handling
961 so this problem goes away. But that's very hairy. */
963 for (i
= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
< max_regno
; i
++)
964 if (reg_renumber
[i
] < 0 && reg_equiv_memory_loc
[i
])
966 rtx x
= eliminate_regs (reg_equiv_memory_loc
[i
], 0, NULL_RTX
);
968 if (strict_memory_address_p (GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx
[i
]),
970 reg_equiv_mem
[i
] = x
, reg_equiv_address
[i
] = 0;
971 else if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x
, 0))
972 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x
, 0)) == REG
973 && REGNO (XEXP (x
, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
974 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x
, 0)) == PLUS
975 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x
, 0), 0)) == REG
976 && (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (x
, 0), 0))
977 < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
978 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x
, 0), 1))))
979 reg_equiv_address
[i
] = XEXP (x
, 0), reg_equiv_mem
[i
] = 0;
982 /* Make a new stack slot. Then indicate that something
983 changed so we go back and recompute offsets for
984 eliminable registers because the allocation of memory
985 below might change some offset. reg_equiv_{mem,address}
986 will be set up for this pseudo on the next pass around
988 reg_equiv_memory_loc
[i
] = 0;
989 reg_equiv_init
[i
] = 0;
994 if (caller_save_needed
)
997 /* If we allocated another stack slot, redo elimination bookkeeping. */
998 if (starting_frame_size
!= get_frame_size ())
1001 if (caller_save_needed
)
1003 save_call_clobbered_regs ();
1004 /* That might have allocated new insn_chain structures. */
1005 reload_firstobj
= (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack
, 0);
1008 calculate_needs_all_insns (global
);
1010 CLEAR_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos
);
1013 something_changed
= 0;
1015 /* If we allocated any new memory locations, make another pass
1016 since it might have changed elimination offsets. */
1017 if (starting_frame_size
!= get_frame_size ())
1018 something_changed
= 1;
1021 HARD_REG_SET to_spill
;
1022 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (to_spill
);
1023 update_eliminables (&to_spill
);
1024 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
1025 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (to_spill
, i
))
1027 spill_hard_reg (i
, 1);
1030 /* Regardless of the state of spills, if we previously had
1031 a register that we thought we could eliminate, but no can
1032 not eliminate, we must run another pass.
1034 Consider pseudos which have an entry in reg_equiv_* which
1035 reference an eliminable register. We must make another pass
1036 to update reg_equiv_* so that we do not substitute in the
1037 old value from when we thought the elimination could be
1039 something_changed
= 1;
1043 select_reload_regs ();
1047 if (insns_need_reload
!= 0 || did_spill
)
1048 something_changed
|= finish_spills (global
);
1050 if (! something_changed
)
1053 if (caller_save_needed
)
1054 delete_caller_save_insns ();
1056 obstack_free (&reload_obstack
, reload_firstobj
);
1059 /* If global-alloc was run, notify it of any register eliminations we have
1062 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++)
1063 if (ep
->can_eliminate
)
1064 mark_elimination (ep
->from
, ep
->to
);
1066 /* If a pseudo has no hard reg, delete the insns that made the equivalence.
1067 If that insn didn't set the register (i.e., it copied the register to
1068 memory), just delete that insn instead of the equivalencing insn plus
1069 anything now dead. If we call delete_dead_insn on that insn, we may
1070 delete the insn that actually sets the register if the register dies
1071 there and that is incorrect. */
1073 for (i
= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
< max_regno
; i
++)
1075 if (reg_renumber
[i
] < 0 && reg_equiv_init
[i
] != 0)
1078 for (list
= reg_equiv_init
[i
]; list
; list
= XEXP (list
, 1))
1080 rtx equiv_insn
= XEXP (list
, 0);
1082 /* If we already deleted the insn or if it may trap, we can't
1083 delete it. The latter case shouldn't happen, but can
1084 if an insn has a variable address, gets a REG_EH_REGION
1085 note added to it, and then gets converted into an load
1086 from a constant address. */
1087 if (GET_CODE (equiv_insn
) == NOTE
1088 || can_throw_internal (equiv_insn
))
1090 else if (reg_set_p (regno_reg_rtx
[i
], PATTERN (equiv_insn
)))
1091 delete_dead_insn (equiv_insn
);
1094 PUT_CODE (equiv_insn
, NOTE
);
1095 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (equiv_insn
) = 0;
1096 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (equiv_insn
) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED
;
1102 /* Use the reload registers where necessary
1103 by generating move instructions to move the must-be-register
1104 values into or out of the reload registers. */
1106 if (insns_need_reload
!= 0 || something_needs_elimination
1107 || something_needs_operands_changed
)
1109 HOST_WIDE_INT old_frame_size
= get_frame_size ();
1111 reload_as_needed (global
);
1113 if (old_frame_size
!= get_frame_size ())
1117 verify_initial_elim_offsets ();
1120 /* If we were able to eliminate the frame pointer, show that it is no
1121 longer live at the start of any basic block. If it ls live by
1122 virtue of being in a pseudo, that pseudo will be marked live
1123 and hence the frame pointer will be known to be live via that
1126 if (! frame_pointer_needed
)
1128 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (bb
->global_live_at_start
,
1129 HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
);
1131 /* Come here (with failure set nonzero) if we can't get enough spill regs
1132 and we decide not to abort about it. */
1135 CLEAR_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos
);
1136 reload_in_progress
= 0;
1138 /* Now eliminate all pseudo regs by modifying them into
1139 their equivalent memory references.
1140 The REG-rtx's for the pseudos are modified in place,
1141 so all insns that used to refer to them now refer to memory.
1143 For a reg that has a reg_equiv_address, all those insns
1144 were changed by reloading so that no insns refer to it any longer;
1145 but the DECL_RTL of a variable decl may refer to it,
1146 and if so this causes the debugging info to mention the variable. */
1148 for (i
= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
< max_regno
; i
++)
1152 if (reg_equiv_mem
[i
])
1153 addr
= XEXP (reg_equiv_mem
[i
], 0);
1155 if (reg_equiv_address
[i
])
1156 addr
= reg_equiv_address
[i
];
1160 if (reg_renumber
[i
] < 0)
1162 rtx reg
= regno_reg_rtx
[i
];
1164 REG_USERVAR_P (reg
) = 0;
1165 PUT_CODE (reg
, MEM
);
1166 XEXP (reg
, 0) = addr
;
1167 if (reg_equiv_memory_loc
[i
])
1168 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (reg
, reg_equiv_memory_loc
[i
]);
1171 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (reg
) = MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (reg
)
1172 = MEM_SCALAR_P (reg
) = 0;
1173 MEM_ATTRS (reg
) = 0;
1176 else if (reg_equiv_mem
[i
])
1177 XEXP (reg_equiv_mem
[i
], 0) = addr
;
1181 /* We must set reload_completed now since the cleanup_subreg_operands call
1182 below will re-recognize each insn and reload may have generated insns
1183 which are only valid during and after reload. */
1184 reload_completed
= 1;
1186 /* Make a pass over all the insns and delete all USEs which we inserted
1187 only to tag a REG_EQUAL note on them. Remove all REG_DEAD and REG_UNUSED
1188 notes. Delete all CLOBBER insns that don't refer to the return value
1189 and simplify (subreg (reg)) operands. Also remove all REG_RETVAL and
1190 REG_LIBCALL notes since they are no longer useful or accurate. Strip
1191 and regenerate REG_INC notes that may have been moved around. */
1193 for (insn
= first
; insn
; insn
= NEXT_INSN (insn
))
1198 if (GET_CODE (insn
) == CALL_INSN
)
1199 replace_pseudos_in_call_usage (& CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn
),
1201 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn
));
1203 if ((GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn
)) == USE
1204 /* We mark with QImode USEs introduced by reload itself. */
1205 && (GET_MODE (insn
) == QImode
1206 || find_reg_note (insn
, REG_EQUAL
, NULL_RTX
)))
1207 || (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn
)) == CLOBBER
1208 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn
), 0)) != REG
1209 || ! REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn
), 0)))))
1215 pnote
= ®_NOTES (insn
);
1218 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote
) == REG_DEAD
1219 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote
) == REG_UNUSED
1220 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote
) == REG_INC
1221 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote
) == REG_RETVAL
1222 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote
) == REG_LIBCALL
)
1223 *pnote
= XEXP (*pnote
, 1);
1225 pnote
= &XEXP (*pnote
, 1);
1229 add_auto_inc_notes (insn
, PATTERN (insn
));
1232 /* And simplify (subreg (reg)) if it appears as an operand. */
1233 cleanup_subreg_operands (insn
);
1236 /* If we are doing stack checking, give a warning if this function's
1237 frame size is larger than we expect. */
1238 if (flag_stack_check
&& ! STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
)
1240 HOST_WIDE_INT size
= get_frame_size () + STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
;
1241 static int verbose_warned
= 0;
1243 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
1244 if (regs_ever_live
[i
] && ! fixed_regs
[i
] && call_used_regs
[i
])
1245 size
+= UNITS_PER_WORD
;
1247 if (size
> STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
)
1249 warning ("frame size too large for reliable stack checking");
1250 if (! verbose_warned
)
1252 warning ("try reducing the number of local variables");
1258 /* Indicate that we no longer have known memory locations or constants. */
1259 if (reg_equiv_constant
)
1260 free (reg_equiv_constant
);
1261 reg_equiv_constant
= 0;
1262 if (reg_equiv_memory_loc
)
1263 free (reg_equiv_memory_loc
);
1264 reg_equiv_memory_loc
= 0;
1267 free (real_known_ptr
);
1271 free (reg_equiv_mem
);
1272 free (reg_equiv_init
);
1273 free (reg_equiv_address
);
1274 free (reg_max_ref_width
);
1275 free (reg_old_renumber
);
1276 free (pseudo_previous_regs
);
1277 free (pseudo_forbidden_regs
);
1279 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs
);
1280 for (i
= 0; i
< n_spills
; i
++)
1281 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs
, spill_regs
[i
]);
1283 /* Free all the insn_chain structures at once. */
1284 obstack_free (&reload_obstack
, reload_startobj
);
1285 unused_insn_chains
= 0;
1286 fixup_abnormal_edges ();
1288 /* Replacing pseudos with their memory equivalents might have
1289 created shared rtx. Subsequent passes would get confused
1290 by this, so unshare everything here. */
1291 unshare_all_rtl_again (first
);
1296 /* Yet another special case. Unfortunately, reg-stack forces people to
1297 write incorrect clobbers in asm statements. These clobbers must not
1298 cause the register to appear in bad_spill_regs, otherwise we'll call
1299 fatal_insn later. We clear the corresponding regnos in the live
1300 register sets to avoid this.
1301 The whole thing is rather sick, I'm afraid. */
1304 maybe_fix_stack_asms ()
1307 const char *constraints
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
1308 enum machine_mode operand_mode
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
1309 struct insn_chain
*chain
;
1311 for (chain
= reload_insn_chain
; chain
!= 0; chain
= chain
->next
)
1314 HARD_REG_SET clobbered
, allowed
;
1317 if (! INSN_P (chain
->insn
)
1318 || (noperands
= asm_noperands (PATTERN (chain
->insn
))) < 0)
1320 pat
= PATTERN (chain
->insn
);
1321 if (GET_CODE (pat
) != PARALLEL
)
1324 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (clobbered
);
1325 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (allowed
);
1327 /* First, make a mask of all stack regs that are clobbered. */
1328 for (i
= 0; i
< XVECLEN (pat
, 0); i
++)
1330 rtx t
= XVECEXP (pat
, 0, i
);
1331 if (GET_CODE (t
) == CLOBBER
&& STACK_REG_P (XEXP (t
, 0)))
1332 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (clobbered
, REGNO (XEXP (t
, 0)));
1335 /* Get the operand values and constraints out of the insn. */
1336 decode_asm_operands (pat
, recog_data
.operand
, recog_data
.operand_loc
,
1337 constraints
, operand_mode
);
1339 /* For every operand, see what registers are allowed. */
1340 for (i
= 0; i
< noperands
; i
++)
1342 const char *p
= constraints
[i
];
1343 /* For every alternative, we compute the class of registers allowed
1344 for reloading in CLS, and merge its contents into the reg set
1346 int cls
= (int) NO_REGS
;
1352 if (c
== '\0' || c
== ',' || c
== '#')
1354 /* End of one alternative - mark the regs in the current
1355 class, and reset the class. */
1356 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (allowed
, reg_class_contents
[cls
]);
1361 } while (c
!= '\0' && c
!= ',');
1369 case '=': case '+': case '*': case '%': case '?': case '!':
1370 case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4': case 'm':
1371 case '<': case '>': case 'V': case 'o': case '&': case 'E':
1372 case 'F': case 's': case 'i': case 'n': case 'X': case 'I':
1373 case 'J': case 'K': case 'L': case 'M': case 'N': case 'O':
1378 cls
= (int) reg_class_subunion
[cls
]
1379 [(int) MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (VOIDmode
)];
1384 cls
= (int) reg_class_subunion
[cls
][(int) GENERAL_REGS
];
1388 cls
= (int) reg_class_subunion
[cls
][(int) REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (c
)];
1393 /* Those of the registers which are clobbered, but allowed by the
1394 constraints, must be usable as reload registers. So clear them
1395 out of the life information. */
1396 AND_HARD_REG_SET (allowed
, clobbered
);
1397 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
1398 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (allowed
, i
))
1400 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&chain
->live_throughout
, i
);
1401 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&chain
->dead_or_set
, i
);
1408 /* Copy the global variables n_reloads and rld into the corresponding elts
1411 copy_reloads (chain
)
1412 struct insn_chain
*chain
;
1414 chain
->n_reloads
= n_reloads
;
1416 = (struct reload
*) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack
,
1417 n_reloads
* sizeof (struct reload
));
1418 memcpy (chain
->rld
, rld
, n_reloads
* sizeof (struct reload
));
1419 reload_insn_firstobj
= (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack
, 0);
1422 /* Walk the chain of insns, and determine for each whether it needs reloads
1423 and/or eliminations. Build the corresponding insns_need_reload list, and
1424 set something_needs_elimination as appropriate. */
1426 calculate_needs_all_insns (global
)
1429 struct insn_chain
**pprev_reload
= &insns_need_reload
;
1430 struct insn_chain
*chain
, *next
= 0;
1432 something_needs_elimination
= 0;
1434 reload_insn_firstobj
= (char *) obstack_alloc (&reload_obstack
, 0);
1435 for (chain
= reload_insn_chain
; chain
!= 0; chain
= next
)
1437 rtx insn
= chain
->insn
;
1441 /* Clear out the shortcuts. */
1442 chain
->n_reloads
= 0;
1443 chain
->need_elim
= 0;
1444 chain
->need_reload
= 0;
1445 chain
->need_operand_change
= 0;
1447 /* If this is a label, a JUMP_INSN, or has REG_NOTES (which might
1448 include REG_LABEL), we need to see what effects this has on the
1449 known offsets at labels. */
1451 if (GET_CODE (insn
) == CODE_LABEL
|| GET_CODE (insn
) == JUMP_INSN
1452 || (INSN_P (insn
) && REG_NOTES (insn
) != 0))
1453 set_label_offsets (insn
, insn
, 0);
1457 rtx old_body
= PATTERN (insn
);
1458 int old_code
= INSN_CODE (insn
);
1459 rtx old_notes
= REG_NOTES (insn
);
1460 int did_elimination
= 0;
1461 int operands_changed
= 0;
1462 rtx set
= single_set (insn
);
1464 /* Skip insns that only set an equivalence. */
1465 if (set
&& GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set
)) == REG
1466 && reg_renumber
[REGNO (SET_DEST (set
))] < 0
1467 && reg_equiv_constant
[REGNO (SET_DEST (set
))])
1470 /* If needed, eliminate any eliminable registers. */
1471 if (num_eliminable
|| num_eliminable_invariants
)
1472 did_elimination
= eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn
, 0);
1474 /* Analyze the instruction. */
1475 operands_changed
= find_reloads (insn
, 0, spill_indirect_levels
,
1476 global
, spill_reg_order
);
1478 /* If a no-op set needs more than one reload, this is likely
1479 to be something that needs input address reloads. We
1480 can't get rid of this cleanly later, and it is of no use
1481 anyway, so discard it now.
1482 We only do this when expensive_optimizations is enabled,
1483 since this complements reload inheritance / output
1484 reload deletion, and it can make debugging harder. */
1485 if (flag_expensive_optimizations
&& n_reloads
> 1)
1487 rtx set
= single_set (insn
);
1489 && SET_SRC (set
) == SET_DEST (set
)
1490 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set
)) == REG
1491 && REGNO (SET_SRC (set
)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
1494 /* Delete it from the reload chain */
1496 chain
->prev
->next
= next
;
1498 reload_insn_chain
= next
;
1500 next
->prev
= chain
->prev
;
1501 chain
->next
= unused_insn_chains
;
1502 unused_insn_chains
= chain
;
1507 update_eliminable_offsets ();
1509 /* Remember for later shortcuts which insns had any reloads or
1510 register eliminations. */
1511 chain
->need_elim
= did_elimination
;
1512 chain
->need_reload
= n_reloads
> 0;
1513 chain
->need_operand_change
= operands_changed
;
1515 /* Discard any register replacements done. */
1516 if (did_elimination
)
1518 obstack_free (&reload_obstack
, reload_insn_firstobj
);
1519 PATTERN (insn
) = old_body
;
1520 INSN_CODE (insn
) = old_code
;
1521 REG_NOTES (insn
) = old_notes
;
1522 something_needs_elimination
= 1;
1525 something_needs_operands_changed
|= operands_changed
;
1529 copy_reloads (chain
);
1530 *pprev_reload
= chain
;
1531 pprev_reload
= &chain
->next_need_reload
;
1538 /* Comparison function for qsort to decide which of two reloads
1539 should be handled first. *P1 and *P2 are the reload numbers. */
1542 reload_reg_class_lower (r1p
, r2p
)
1546 int r1
= *(const short *) r1p
, r2
= *(const short *) r2p
;
1549 /* Consider required reloads before optional ones. */
1550 t
= rld
[r1
].optional
- rld
[r2
].optional
;
1554 /* Count all solitary classes before non-solitary ones. */
1555 t
= ((reg_class_size
[(int) rld
[r2
].class] == 1)
1556 - (reg_class_size
[(int) rld
[r1
].class] == 1));
1560 /* Aside from solitaires, consider all multi-reg groups first. */
1561 t
= rld
[r2
].nregs
- rld
[r1
].nregs
;
1565 /* Consider reloads in order of increasing reg-class number. */
1566 t
= (int) rld
[r1
].class - (int) rld
[r2
].class;
1570 /* If reloads are equally urgent, sort by reload number,
1571 so that the results of qsort leave nothing to chance. */
1575 /* The cost of spilling each hard reg. */
1576 static int spill_cost
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
1578 /* When spilling multiple hard registers, we use SPILL_COST for the first
1579 spilled hard reg and SPILL_ADD_COST for subsequent regs. SPILL_ADD_COST
1580 only the first hard reg for a multi-reg pseudo. */
1581 static int spill_add_cost
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
1583 /* Update the spill cost arrays, considering that pseudo REG is live. */
1589 int freq
= REG_FREQ (reg
);
1590 int r
= reg_renumber
[reg
];
1593 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (&pseudos_counted
, reg
)
1594 || REGNO_REG_SET_P (&spilled_pseudos
, reg
))
1597 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted
, reg
);
1602 spill_add_cost
[r
] += freq
;
1604 nregs
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (r
, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (reg
));
1606 spill_cost
[r
+ nregs
] += freq
;
1609 /* Calculate the SPILL_COST and SPILL_ADD_COST arrays and determine the
1610 contents of BAD_SPILL_REGS for the insn described by CHAIN. */
1613 order_regs_for_reload (chain
)
1614 struct insn_chain
*chain
;
1617 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos
;
1618 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos2
;
1620 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs
, fixed_reg_set
);
1622 memset (spill_cost
, 0, sizeof spill_cost
);
1623 memset (spill_add_cost
, 0, sizeof spill_add_cost
);
1625 /* Count number of uses of each hard reg by pseudo regs allocated to it
1626 and then order them by decreasing use. First exclude hard registers
1627 that are live in or across this insn. */
1629 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos
, &chain
->live_throughout
);
1630 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2
, &chain
->dead_or_set
);
1631 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs
, used_by_pseudos
);
1632 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs
, used_by_pseudos2
);
1634 /* Now find out which pseudos are allocated to it, and update
1636 CLEAR_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted
);
1638 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1639 (&chain
->live_throughout
, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
, i
,
1643 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1644 (&chain
->dead_or_set
, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
, i
,
1648 CLEAR_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted
);
1651 /* Vector of reload-numbers showing the order in which the reloads should
1653 static short reload_order
[MAX_RELOADS
];
1655 /* This is used to keep track of the spill regs used in one insn. */
1656 static HARD_REG_SET used_spill_regs_local
;
1658 /* We decided to spill hard register SPILLED, which has a size of
1659 SPILLED_NREGS. Determine how pseudo REG, which is live during the insn,
1660 is affected. We will add it to SPILLED_PSEUDOS if necessary, and we will
1661 update SPILL_COST/SPILL_ADD_COST. */
1664 count_spilled_pseudo (spilled
, spilled_nregs
, reg
)
1665 int spilled
, spilled_nregs
, reg
;
1667 int r
= reg_renumber
[reg
];
1668 int nregs
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (r
, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (reg
));
1670 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (&spilled_pseudos
, reg
)
1671 || spilled
+ spilled_nregs
<= r
|| r
+ nregs
<= spilled
)
1674 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos
, reg
);
1676 spill_add_cost
[r
] -= REG_FREQ (reg
);
1678 spill_cost
[r
+ nregs
] -= REG_FREQ (reg
);
1681 /* Find reload register to use for reload number ORDER. */
1684 find_reg (chain
, order
)
1685 struct insn_chain
*chain
;
1688 int rnum
= reload_order
[order
];
1689 struct reload
*rl
= rld
+ rnum
;
1690 int best_cost
= INT_MAX
;
1694 HARD_REG_SET not_usable
;
1695 HARD_REG_SET used_by_other_reload
;
1697 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable
, bad_spill_regs
);
1698 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable
, bad_spill_regs_global
);
1699 IOR_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable
, reg_class_contents
[rl
->class]);
1701 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_other_reload
);
1702 for (k
= 0; k
< order
; k
++)
1704 int other
= reload_order
[k
];
1706 if (rld
[other
].regno
>= 0 && reloads_conflict (other
, rnum
))
1707 for (j
= 0; j
< rld
[other
].nregs
; j
++)
1708 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload
, rld
[other
].regno
+ j
);
1711 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
1713 unsigned int regno
= i
;
1715 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (not_usable
, regno
)
1716 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload
, regno
)
1717 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno
, rl
->mode
))
1719 int this_cost
= spill_cost
[regno
];
1721 unsigned int this_nregs
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno
, rl
->mode
);
1723 for (j
= 1; j
< this_nregs
; j
++)
1725 this_cost
+= spill_add_cost
[regno
+ j
];
1726 if ((TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (not_usable
, regno
+ j
))
1727 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload
, regno
+ j
))
1732 if (rl
->in
&& GET_CODE (rl
->in
) == REG
&& REGNO (rl
->in
) == regno
)
1734 if (rl
->out
&& GET_CODE (rl
->out
) == REG
&& REGNO (rl
->out
) == regno
)
1736 if (this_cost
< best_cost
1737 /* Among registers with equal cost, prefer caller-saved ones, or
1738 use REG_ALLOC_ORDER if it is defined. */
1739 || (this_cost
== best_cost
1740 #ifdef REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1741 && (inv_reg_alloc_order
[regno
]
1742 < inv_reg_alloc_order
[best_reg
])
1744 && call_used_regs
[regno
]
1745 && ! call_used_regs
[best_reg
]
1750 best_cost
= this_cost
;
1758 fprintf (rtl_dump_file
, "Using reg %d for reload %d\n", best_reg
, rnum
);
1760 rl
->nregs
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (best_reg
, rl
->mode
);
1761 rl
->regno
= best_reg
;
1763 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1764 (&chain
->live_throughout
, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
, j
,
1766 count_spilled_pseudo (best_reg
, rl
->nregs
, j
);
1769 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1770 (&chain
->dead_or_set
, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
, j
,
1772 count_spilled_pseudo (best_reg
, rl
->nregs
, j
);
1775 for (i
= 0; i
< rl
->nregs
; i
++)
1777 if (spill_cost
[best_reg
+ i
] != 0
1778 || spill_add_cost
[best_reg
+ i
] != 0)
1780 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs_local
, best_reg
+ i
);
1785 /* Find more reload regs to satisfy the remaining need of an insn, which
1787 Do it by ascending class number, since otherwise a reg
1788 might be spilled for a big class and might fail to count
1789 for a smaller class even though it belongs to that class. */
1792 find_reload_regs (chain
)
1793 struct insn_chain
*chain
;
1797 /* In order to be certain of getting the registers we need,
1798 we must sort the reloads into order of increasing register class.
1799 Then our grabbing of reload registers will parallel the process
1800 that provided the reload registers. */
1801 for (i
= 0; i
< chain
->n_reloads
; i
++)
1803 /* Show whether this reload already has a hard reg. */
1804 if (chain
->rld
[i
].reg_rtx
)
1806 int regno
= REGNO (chain
->rld
[i
].reg_rtx
);
1807 chain
->rld
[i
].regno
= regno
;
1809 = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno
, GET_MODE (chain
->rld
[i
].reg_rtx
));
1812 chain
->rld
[i
].regno
= -1;
1813 reload_order
[i
] = i
;
1816 n_reloads
= chain
->n_reloads
;
1817 memcpy (rld
, chain
->rld
, n_reloads
* sizeof (struct reload
));
1819 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs_local
);
1822 fprintf (rtl_dump_file
, "Spilling for insn %d.\n", INSN_UID (chain
->insn
));
1824 qsort (reload_order
, n_reloads
, sizeof (short), reload_reg_class_lower
);
1826 /* Compute the order of preference for hard registers to spill. */
1828 order_regs_for_reload (chain
);
1830 for (i
= 0; i
< n_reloads
; i
++)
1832 int r
= reload_order
[i
];
1834 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
1835 if ((rld
[r
].out
!= 0 || rld
[r
].in
!= 0 || rld
[r
].secondary_p
)
1836 && ! rld
[r
].optional
1837 && rld
[r
].regno
== -1)
1838 if (! find_reg (chain
, i
))
1840 spill_failure (chain
->insn
, rld
[r
].class);
1846 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (chain
->used_spill_regs
, used_spill_regs_local
);
1847 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs
, used_spill_regs_local
);
1849 memcpy (chain
->rld
, rld
, n_reloads
* sizeof (struct reload
));
1853 select_reload_regs ()
1855 struct insn_chain
*chain
;
1857 /* Try to satisfy the needs for each insn. */
1858 for (chain
= insns_need_reload
; chain
!= 0;
1859 chain
= chain
->next_need_reload
)
1860 find_reload_regs (chain
);
1863 /* Delete all insns that were inserted by emit_caller_save_insns during
1866 delete_caller_save_insns ()
1868 struct insn_chain
*c
= reload_insn_chain
;
1872 while (c
!= 0 && c
->is_caller_save_insn
)
1874 struct insn_chain
*next
= c
->next
;
1877 if (c
== reload_insn_chain
)
1878 reload_insn_chain
= next
;
1882 next
->prev
= c
->prev
;
1884 c
->prev
->next
= next
;
1885 c
->next
= unused_insn_chains
;
1886 unused_insn_chains
= c
;
1894 /* Handle the failure to find a register to spill.
1895 INSN should be one of the insns which needed this particular spill reg. */
1898 spill_failure (insn
, class)
1900 enum reg_class
class;
1902 static const char *const reg_class_names
[] = REG_CLASS_NAMES
;
1903 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn
)) >= 0)
1904 error_for_asm (insn
, "can't find a register in class `%s' while reloading `asm'",
1905 reg_class_names
[class]);
1908 error ("unable to find a register to spill in class `%s'",
1909 reg_class_names
[class]);
1910 fatal_insn ("this is the insn:", insn
);
1914 /* Delete an unneeded INSN and any previous insns who sole purpose is loading
1915 data that is dead in INSN. */
1918 delete_dead_insn (insn
)
1921 rtx prev
= prev_real_insn (insn
);
1924 /* If the previous insn sets a register that dies in our insn, delete it
1926 if (prev
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev
)) == SET
1927 && (prev_dest
= SET_DEST (PATTERN (prev
)), GET_CODE (prev_dest
) == REG
)
1928 && reg_mentioned_p (prev_dest
, PATTERN (insn
))
1929 && find_regno_note (insn
, REG_DEAD
, REGNO (prev_dest
))
1930 && ! side_effects_p (SET_SRC (PATTERN (prev
))))
1931 delete_dead_insn (prev
);
1933 PUT_CODE (insn
, NOTE
);
1934 NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn
) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED
;
1935 NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn
) = 0;
1938 /* Modify the home of pseudo-reg I.
1939 The new home is present in reg_renumber[I].
1941 FROM_REG may be the hard reg that the pseudo-reg is being spilled from;
1942 or it may be -1, meaning there is none or it is not relevant.
1943 This is used so that all pseudos spilled from a given hard reg
1944 can share one stack slot. */
1947 alter_reg (i
, from_reg
)
1951 /* When outputting an inline function, this can happen
1952 for a reg that isn't actually used. */
1953 if (regno_reg_rtx
[i
] == 0)
1956 /* If the reg got changed to a MEM at rtl-generation time,
1958 if (GET_CODE (regno_reg_rtx
[i
]) != REG
)
1961 /* Modify the reg-rtx to contain the new hard reg
1962 number or else to contain its pseudo reg number. */
1963 REGNO (regno_reg_rtx
[i
])
1964 = reg_renumber
[i
] >= 0 ? reg_renumber
[i
] : i
;
1966 /* If we have a pseudo that is needed but has no hard reg or equivalent,
1967 allocate a stack slot for it. */
1969 if (reg_renumber
[i
] < 0
1970 && REG_N_REFS (i
) > 0
1971 && reg_equiv_constant
[i
] == 0
1972 && reg_equiv_memory_loc
[i
] == 0)
1975 unsigned int inherent_size
= PSEUDO_REGNO_BYTES (i
);
1976 unsigned int total_size
= MAX (inherent_size
, reg_max_ref_width
[i
]);
1979 /* Each pseudo reg has an inherent size which comes from its own mode,
1980 and a total size which provides room for paradoxical subregs
1981 which refer to the pseudo reg in wider modes.
1983 We can use a slot already allocated if it provides both
1984 enough inherent space and enough total space.
1985 Otherwise, we allocate a new slot, making sure that it has no less
1986 inherent space, and no less total space, then the previous slot. */
1989 /* No known place to spill from => no slot to reuse. */
1990 x
= assign_stack_local (GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx
[i
]), total_size
,
1991 inherent_size
== total_size
? 0 : -1);
1992 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
)
1993 /* Cancel the big-endian correction done in assign_stack_local.
1994 Get the address of the beginning of the slot.
1995 This is so we can do a big-endian correction unconditionally
1997 adjust
= inherent_size
- total_size
;
1999 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (x
) = RTX_UNCHANGING_P (regno_reg_rtx
[i
]);
2001 /* Nothing can alias this slot except this pseudo. */
2002 set_mem_alias_set (x
, new_alias_set ());
2005 /* Reuse a stack slot if possible. */
2006 else if (spill_stack_slot
[from_reg
] != 0
2007 && spill_stack_slot_width
[from_reg
] >= total_size
2008 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot
[from_reg
]))
2010 x
= spill_stack_slot
[from_reg
];
2012 /* Allocate a bigger slot. */
2015 /* Compute maximum size needed, both for inherent size
2016 and for total size. */
2017 enum machine_mode mode
= GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx
[i
]);
2020 if (spill_stack_slot
[from_reg
])
2022 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot
[from_reg
]))
2024 mode
= GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot
[from_reg
]);
2025 if (spill_stack_slot_width
[from_reg
] > total_size
)
2026 total_size
= spill_stack_slot_width
[from_reg
];
2029 /* Make a slot with that size. */
2030 x
= assign_stack_local (mode
, total_size
,
2031 inherent_size
== total_size
? 0 : -1);
2034 /* All pseudos mapped to this slot can alias each other. */
2035 if (spill_stack_slot
[from_reg
])
2036 set_mem_alias_set (x
, MEM_ALIAS_SET (spill_stack_slot
[from_reg
]));
2038 set_mem_alias_set (x
, new_alias_set ());
2040 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
)
2042 /* Cancel the big-endian correction done in assign_stack_local.
2043 Get the address of the beginning of the slot.
2044 This is so we can do a big-endian correction unconditionally
2046 adjust
= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
) - total_size
;
2049 = adjust_address_nv (x
, mode_for_size (total_size
2055 spill_stack_slot
[from_reg
] = stack_slot
;
2056 spill_stack_slot_width
[from_reg
] = total_size
;
2059 /* On a big endian machine, the "address" of the slot
2060 is the address of the low part that fits its inherent mode. */
2061 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
&& inherent_size
< total_size
)
2062 adjust
+= (total_size
- inherent_size
);
2064 /* If we have any adjustment to make, or if the stack slot is the
2065 wrong mode, make a new stack slot. */
2066 x
= adjust_address_nv (x
, GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx
[i
]), adjust
);
2068 /* If we have a decl for the original register, set it for the
2069 memory. If this is a shared MEM, make a copy. */
2072 rtx decl
= DECL_RTL_IF_SET (REGNO_DECL (i
));
2074 /* We can do this only for the DECLs home pseudo, not for
2075 any copies of it, since otherwise when the stack slot
2076 is reused, nonoverlapping_memrefs_p might think they
2078 if (decl
&& GET_CODE (decl
) == REG
&& REGNO (decl
) == (unsigned) i
)
2080 if (from_reg
!= -1 && spill_stack_slot
[from_reg
] == x
)
2083 set_mem_expr (x
, REGNO_DECL (i
));
2087 /* Save the stack slot for later. */
2088 reg_equiv_memory_loc
[i
] = x
;
2092 /* Mark the slots in regs_ever_live for the hard regs
2093 used by pseudo-reg number REGNO. */
2096 mark_home_live (regno
)
2101 i
= reg_renumber
[regno
];
2104 lim
= i
+ HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i
, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (regno
));
2106 regs_ever_live
[i
++] = 1;
2109 /* This function handles the tracking of elimination offsets around branches.
2111 X is a piece of RTL being scanned.
2113 INSN is the insn that it came from, if any.
2115 INITIAL_P is non-zero if we are to set the offset to be the initial
2116 offset and zero if we are setting the offset of the label to be the
2120 set_label_offsets (x
, insn
, initial_p
)
2125 enum rtx_code code
= GET_CODE (x
);
2128 struct elim_table
*p
;
2133 if (LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (x
))
2138 /* ... fall through ... */
2141 /* If we know nothing about this label, set the desired offsets. Note
2142 that this sets the offset at a label to be the offset before a label
2143 if we don't know anything about the label. This is not correct for
2144 the label after a BARRIER, but is the best guess we can make. If
2145 we guessed wrong, we will suppress an elimination that might have
2146 been possible had we been able to guess correctly. */
2148 if (! offsets_known_at
[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x
)])
2150 for (i
= 0; i
< NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
; i
++)
2151 offsets_at
[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x
)][i
]
2152 = (initial_p
? reg_eliminate
[i
].initial_offset
2153 : reg_eliminate
[i
].offset
);
2154 offsets_known_at
[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x
)] = 1;
2157 /* Otherwise, if this is the definition of a label and it is
2158 preceded by a BARRIER, set our offsets to the known offset of
2162 && (tem
= prev_nonnote_insn (insn
)) != 0
2163 && GET_CODE (tem
) == BARRIER
)
2164 set_offsets_for_label (insn
);
2166 /* If neither of the above cases is true, compare each offset
2167 with those previously recorded and suppress any eliminations
2168 where the offsets disagree. */
2170 for (i
= 0; i
< NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
; i
++)
2171 if (offsets_at
[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x
)][i
]
2172 != (initial_p
? reg_eliminate
[i
].initial_offset
2173 : reg_eliminate
[i
].offset
))
2174 reg_eliminate
[i
].can_eliminate
= 0;
2179 set_label_offsets (PATTERN (insn
), insn
, initial_p
);
2181 /* ... fall through ... */
2185 /* Any labels mentioned in REG_LABEL notes can be branched to indirectly
2186 and hence must have all eliminations at their initial offsets. */
2187 for (tem
= REG_NOTES (x
); tem
; tem
= XEXP (tem
, 1))
2188 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (tem
) == REG_LABEL
)
2189 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem
, 0), insn
, 1);
2195 /* Each of the labels in the parallel or address vector must be
2196 at their initial offsets. We want the first field for PARALLEL
2197 and ADDR_VEC and the second field for ADDR_DIFF_VEC. */
2199 for (i
= 0; i
< (unsigned) XVECLEN (x
, code
== ADDR_DIFF_VEC
); i
++)
2200 set_label_offsets (XVECEXP (x
, code
== ADDR_DIFF_VEC
, i
),
2205 /* We only care about setting PC. If the source is not RETURN,
2206 IF_THEN_ELSE, or a label, disable any eliminations not at
2207 their initial offsets. Similarly if any arm of the IF_THEN_ELSE
2208 isn't one of those possibilities. For branches to a label,
2209 call ourselves recursively.
2211 Note that this can disable elimination unnecessarily when we have
2212 a non-local goto since it will look like a non-constant jump to
2213 someplace in the current function. This isn't a significant
2214 problem since such jumps will normally be when all elimination
2215 pairs are back to their initial offsets. */
2217 if (SET_DEST (x
) != pc_rtx
)
2220 switch (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x
)))
2227 set_label_offsets (XEXP (SET_SRC (x
), 0), insn
, initial_p
);
2231 tem
= XEXP (SET_SRC (x
), 1);
2232 if (GET_CODE (tem
) == LABEL_REF
)
2233 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem
, 0), insn
, initial_p
);
2234 else if (GET_CODE (tem
) != PC
&& GET_CODE (tem
) != RETURN
)
2237 tem
= XEXP (SET_SRC (x
), 2);
2238 if (GET_CODE (tem
) == LABEL_REF
)
2239 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem
, 0), insn
, initial_p
);
2240 else if (GET_CODE (tem
) != PC
&& GET_CODE (tem
) != RETURN
)
2248 /* If we reach here, all eliminations must be at their initial
2249 offset because we are doing a jump to a variable address. */
2250 for (p
= reg_eliminate
; p
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; p
++)
2251 if (p
->offset
!= p
->initial_offset
)
2252 p
->can_eliminate
= 0;
2260 /* Scan X and replace any eliminable registers (such as fp) with a
2261 replacement (such as sp), plus an offset.
2263 MEM_MODE is the mode of an enclosing MEM. We need this to know how
2264 much to adjust a register for, e.g., PRE_DEC. Also, if we are inside a
2265 MEM, we are allowed to replace a sum of a register and the constant zero
2266 with the register, which we cannot do outside a MEM. In addition, we need
2267 to record the fact that a register is referenced outside a MEM.
2269 If INSN is an insn, it is the insn containing X. If we replace a REG
2270 in a SET_DEST with an equivalent MEM and INSN is non-zero, write a
2271 CLOBBER of the pseudo after INSN so find_equiv_regs will know that
2272 the REG is being modified.
2274 Alternatively, INSN may be a note (an EXPR_LIST or INSN_LIST).
2275 That's used when we eliminate in expressions stored in notes.
2276 This means, do not set ref_outside_mem even if the reference
2279 REG_EQUIV_MEM and REG_EQUIV_ADDRESS contain address that have had
2280 replacements done assuming all offsets are at their initial values. If
2281 they are not, or if REG_EQUIV_ADDRESS is nonzero for a pseudo we
2282 encounter, return the actual location so that find_reloads will do
2283 the proper thing. */
2286 eliminate_regs (x
, mem_mode
, insn
)
2288 enum machine_mode mem_mode
;
2291 enum rtx_code code
= GET_CODE (x
);
2292 struct elim_table
*ep
;
2299 if (! current_function_decl
)
2319 /* This is only for the benefit of the debugging backends, which call
2320 eliminate_regs on DECL_RTL; any ADDRESSOFs in the actual insns are
2321 removed after CSE. */
2322 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x
, 0), 0, insn
);
2323 if (GET_CODE (new) == MEM
)
2324 return XEXP (new, 0);
2330 /* First handle the case where we encounter a bare register that
2331 is eliminable. Replace it with a PLUS. */
2332 if (regno
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
2334 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
];
2336 if (ep
->from_rtx
== x
&& ep
->can_eliminate
)
2337 return plus_constant (ep
->to_rtx
, ep
->previous_offset
);
2340 else if (reg_renumber
&& reg_renumber
[regno
] < 0
2341 && reg_equiv_constant
&& reg_equiv_constant
[regno
]
2342 && ! CONSTANT_P (reg_equiv_constant
[regno
]))
2343 return eliminate_regs (copy_rtx (reg_equiv_constant
[regno
]),
2347 /* You might think handling MINUS in a manner similar to PLUS is a
2348 good idea. It is not. It has been tried multiple times and every
2349 time the change has had to have been reverted.
2351 Other parts of reload know a PLUS is special (gen_reload for example)
2352 and require special code to handle code a reloaded PLUS operand.
2354 Also consider backends where the flags register is clobbered by a
2355 MINUS, but we can emit a PLUS that does not clobber flags (ia32,
2356 lea instruction comes to mind). If we try to reload a MINUS, we
2357 may kill the flags register that was holding a useful value.
2359 So, please before trying to handle MINUS, consider reload as a
2360 whole instead of this little section as well as the backend issues. */
2362 /* If this is the sum of an eliminable register and a constant, rework
2364 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x
, 0)) == REG
2365 && REGNO (XEXP (x
, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2366 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x
, 1)))
2368 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
];
2370 if (ep
->from_rtx
== XEXP (x
, 0) && ep
->can_eliminate
)
2372 /* The only time we want to replace a PLUS with a REG (this
2373 occurs when the constant operand of the PLUS is the negative
2374 of the offset) is when we are inside a MEM. We won't want
2375 to do so at other times because that would change the
2376 structure of the insn in a way that reload can't handle.
2377 We special-case the commonest situation in
2378 eliminate_regs_in_insn, so just replace a PLUS with a
2379 PLUS here, unless inside a MEM. */
2380 if (mem_mode
!= 0 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x
, 1)) == CONST_INT
2381 && INTVAL (XEXP (x
, 1)) == - ep
->previous_offset
)
2384 return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode
, ep
->to_rtx
,
2385 plus_constant (XEXP (x
, 1),
2386 ep
->previous_offset
));
2389 /* If the register is not eliminable, we are done since the other
2390 operand is a constant. */
2394 /* If this is part of an address, we want to bring any constant to the
2395 outermost PLUS. We will do this by doing register replacement in
2396 our operands and seeing if a constant shows up in one of them.
2398 Note that there is no risk of modifying the structure of the insn,
2399 since we only get called for its operands, thus we are either
2400 modifying the address inside a MEM, or something like an address
2401 operand of a load-address insn. */
2404 rtx new0
= eliminate_regs (XEXP (x
, 0), mem_mode
, insn
);
2405 rtx new1
= eliminate_regs (XEXP (x
, 1), mem_mode
, insn
);
2407 if (reg_renumber
&& (new0
!= XEXP (x
, 0) || new1
!= XEXP (x
, 1)))
2409 /* If one side is a PLUS and the other side is a pseudo that
2410 didn't get a hard register but has a reg_equiv_constant,
2411 we must replace the constant here since it may no longer
2412 be in the position of any operand. */
2413 if (GET_CODE (new0
) == PLUS
&& GET_CODE (new1
) == REG
2414 && REGNO (new1
) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2415 && reg_renumber
[REGNO (new1
)] < 0
2416 && reg_equiv_constant
!= 0
2417 && reg_equiv_constant
[REGNO (new1
)] != 0)
2418 new1
= reg_equiv_constant
[REGNO (new1
)];
2419 else if (GET_CODE (new1
) == PLUS
&& GET_CODE (new0
) == REG
2420 && REGNO (new0
) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2421 && reg_renumber
[REGNO (new0
)] < 0
2422 && reg_equiv_constant
[REGNO (new0
)] != 0)
2423 new0
= reg_equiv_constant
[REGNO (new0
)];
2425 new = form_sum (new0
, new1
);
2427 /* As above, if we are not inside a MEM we do not want to
2428 turn a PLUS into something else. We might try to do so here
2429 for an addition of 0 if we aren't optimizing. */
2430 if (! mem_mode
&& GET_CODE (new) != PLUS
)
2431 return gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x
), new, const0_rtx
);
2439 /* If this is the product of an eliminable register and a
2440 constant, apply the distribute law and move the constant out
2441 so that we have (plus (mult ..) ..). This is needed in order
2442 to keep load-address insns valid. This case is pathological.
2443 We ignore the possibility of overflow here. */
2444 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x
, 0)) == REG
2445 && REGNO (XEXP (x
, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2446 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x
, 1)) == CONST_INT
)
2447 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
];
2449 if (ep
->from_rtx
== XEXP (x
, 0) && ep
->can_eliminate
)
2452 /* Refs inside notes don't count for this purpose. */
2453 && ! (insn
!= 0 && (GET_CODE (insn
) == EXPR_LIST
2454 || GET_CODE (insn
) == INSN_LIST
)))
2455 ep
->ref_outside_mem
= 1;
2458 plus_constant (gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode
, ep
->to_rtx
, XEXP (x
, 1)),
2459 ep
->previous_offset
* INTVAL (XEXP (x
, 1)));
2462 /* ... fall through ... */
2466 /* See comments before PLUS about handling MINUS. */
2468 case DIV
: case UDIV
:
2469 case MOD
: case UMOD
:
2470 case AND
: case IOR
: case XOR
:
2471 case ROTATERT
: case ROTATE
:
2472 case ASHIFTRT
: case LSHIFTRT
: case ASHIFT
:
2474 case GE
: case GT
: case GEU
: case GTU
:
2475 case LE
: case LT
: case LEU
: case LTU
:
2477 rtx new0
= eliminate_regs (XEXP (x
, 0), mem_mode
, insn
);
2479 = XEXP (x
, 1) ? eliminate_regs (XEXP (x
, 1), mem_mode
, insn
) : 0;
2481 if (new0
!= XEXP (x
, 0) || new1
!= XEXP (x
, 1))
2482 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code
, GET_MODE (x
), new0
, new1
);
2487 /* If we have something in XEXP (x, 0), the usual case, eliminate it. */
2490 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x
, 0), mem_mode
, insn
);
2491 if (new != XEXP (x
, 0))
2493 /* If this is a REG_DEAD note, it is not valid anymore.
2494 Using the eliminated version could result in creating a
2495 REG_DEAD note for the stack or frame pointer. */
2496 if (GET_MODE (x
) == REG_DEAD
)
2498 ? eliminate_regs (XEXP (x
, 1), mem_mode
, insn
)
2501 x
= gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (x
), new, XEXP (x
, 1));
2505 /* ... fall through ... */
2508 /* Now do eliminations in the rest of the chain. If this was
2509 an EXPR_LIST, this might result in allocating more memory than is
2510 strictly needed, but it simplifies the code. */
2513 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x
, 1), mem_mode
, insn
);
2514 if (new != XEXP (x
, 1))
2516 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (x
), GET_MODE (x
), XEXP (x
, 0), new);
2524 case STRICT_LOW_PART
:
2526 case SIGN_EXTEND
: case ZERO_EXTEND
:
2527 case TRUNCATE
: case FLOAT_EXTEND
: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE
:
2528 case FLOAT
: case FIX
:
2529 case UNSIGNED_FIX
: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT
:
2533 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x
, 0), mem_mode
, insn
);
2534 if (new != XEXP (x
, 0))
2535 return gen_rtx_fmt_e (code
, GET_MODE (x
), new);
2539 /* Similar to above processing, but preserve SUBREG_BYTE.
2540 Convert (subreg (mem)) to (mem) if not paradoxical.
2541 Also, if we have a non-paradoxical (subreg (pseudo)) and the
2542 pseudo didn't get a hard reg, we must replace this with the
2543 eliminated version of the memory location because push_reloads
2544 may do the replacement in certain circumstances. */
2545 if (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x
)) == REG
2546 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x
))
2547 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x
))))
2548 && reg_equiv_memory_loc
!= 0
2549 && reg_equiv_memory_loc
[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x
))] != 0)
2551 new = SUBREG_REG (x
);
2554 new = eliminate_regs (SUBREG_REG (x
), mem_mode
, insn
);
2556 if (new != SUBREG_REG (x
))
2558 int x_size
= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x
));
2559 int new_size
= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (new));
2561 if (GET_CODE (new) == MEM
2562 && ((x_size
< new_size
2563 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
2564 /* On these machines, combine can create rtl of the form
2565 (set (subreg:m1 (reg:m2 R) 0) ...)
2566 where m1 < m2, and expects something interesting to
2567 happen to the entire word. Moreover, it will use the
2568 (reg:m2 R) later, expecting all bits to be preserved.
2569 So if the number of words is the same, preserve the
2570 subreg so that push_reloads can see it. */
2571 && ! ((x_size
- 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD
2572 == (new_size
-1 ) / UNITS_PER_WORD
)
2575 || x_size
== new_size
)
2577 return adjust_address_nv (new, GET_MODE (x
), SUBREG_BYTE (x
));
2579 return gen_rtx_SUBREG (GET_MODE (x
), new, SUBREG_BYTE (x
));
2585 /* This is only for the benefit of the debugging backends, which call
2586 eliminate_regs on DECL_RTL; any ADDRESSOFs in the actual insns are
2587 removed after CSE. */
2588 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x
, 0)) == ADDRESSOF
)
2589 return eliminate_regs (XEXP (XEXP (x
, 0), 0), 0, insn
);
2591 /* Our only special processing is to pass the mode of the MEM to our
2592 recursive call and copy the flags. While we are here, handle this
2593 case more efficiently. */
2595 replace_equiv_address_nv (x
,
2596 eliminate_regs (XEXP (x
, 0),
2597 GET_MODE (x
), insn
));
2600 /* Handle insn_list USE that a call to a pure function may generate. */
2601 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x
, 0), 0, insn
);
2602 if (new != XEXP (x
, 0))
2603 return gen_rtx_USE (GET_MODE (x
), new);
2615 /* Process each of our operands recursively. If any have changed, make a
2617 fmt
= GET_RTX_FORMAT (code
);
2618 for (i
= 0; i
< GET_RTX_LENGTH (code
); i
++, fmt
++)
2622 new = eliminate_regs (XEXP (x
, i
), mem_mode
, insn
);
2623 if (new != XEXP (x
, i
) && ! copied
)
2625 rtx new_x
= rtx_alloc (code
);
2627 (sizeof (*new_x
) - sizeof (new_x
->fld
)
2628 + sizeof (new_x
->fld
[0]) * GET_RTX_LENGTH (code
)));
2634 else if (*fmt
== 'E')
2637 for (j
= 0; j
< XVECLEN (x
, i
); j
++)
2639 new = eliminate_regs (XVECEXP (x
, i
, j
), mem_mode
, insn
);
2640 if (new != XVECEXP (x
, i
, j
) && ! copied_vec
)
2642 rtvec new_v
= gen_rtvec_v (XVECLEN (x
, i
),
2646 rtx new_x
= rtx_alloc (code
);
2648 (sizeof (*new_x
) - sizeof (new_x
->fld
)
2649 + (sizeof (new_x
->fld
[0])
2650 * GET_RTX_LENGTH (code
))));
2654 XVEC (x
, i
) = new_v
;
2657 XVECEXP (x
, i
, j
) = new;
2665 /* Scan rtx X for modifications of elimination target registers. Update
2666 the table of eliminables to reflect the changed state. MEM_MODE is
2667 the mode of an enclosing MEM rtx, or VOIDmode if not within a MEM. */
2670 elimination_effects (x
, mem_mode
)
2672 enum machine_mode mem_mode
;
2675 enum rtx_code code
= GET_CODE (x
);
2676 struct elim_table
*ep
;
2703 /* First handle the case where we encounter a bare register that
2704 is eliminable. Replace it with a PLUS. */
2705 if (regno
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
2707 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
];
2709 if (ep
->from_rtx
== x
&& ep
->can_eliminate
)
2712 ep
->ref_outside_mem
= 1;
2717 else if (reg_renumber
[regno
] < 0 && reg_equiv_constant
2718 && reg_equiv_constant
[regno
]
2719 && ! function_invariant_p (reg_equiv_constant
[regno
]))
2720 elimination_effects (reg_equiv_constant
[regno
], mem_mode
);
2729 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++)
2730 if (ep
->to_rtx
== XEXP (x
, 0))
2732 int size
= GET_MODE_SIZE (mem_mode
);
2734 /* If more bytes than MEM_MODE are pushed, account for them. */
2735 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
2736 if (ep
->to_rtx
== stack_pointer_rtx
)
2737 size
= PUSH_ROUNDING (size
);
2739 if (code
== PRE_DEC
|| code
== POST_DEC
)
2741 else if (code
== PRE_INC
|| code
== POST_INC
)
2743 else if ((code
== PRE_MODIFY
|| code
== POST_MODIFY
)
2744 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x
, 1)) == PLUS
2745 && XEXP (x
, 0) == XEXP (XEXP (x
, 1), 0)
2746 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x
, 1), 1)))
2747 ep
->offset
-= INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x
, 1), 1));
2750 /* These two aren't unary operators. */
2751 if (code
== POST_MODIFY
|| code
== PRE_MODIFY
)
2754 /* Fall through to generic unary operation case. */
2755 case STRICT_LOW_PART
:
2757 case SIGN_EXTEND
: case ZERO_EXTEND
:
2758 case TRUNCATE
: case FLOAT_EXTEND
: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE
:
2759 case FLOAT
: case FIX
:
2760 case UNSIGNED_FIX
: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT
:
2764 elimination_effects (XEXP (x
, 0), mem_mode
);
2768 if (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x
)) == REG
2769 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x
))
2770 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x
))))
2771 && reg_equiv_memory_loc
!= 0
2772 && reg_equiv_memory_loc
[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x
))] != 0)
2775 elimination_effects (SUBREG_REG (x
), mem_mode
);
2779 /* If using a register that is the source of an eliminate we still
2780 think can be performed, note it cannot be performed since we don't
2781 know how this register is used. */
2782 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++)
2783 if (ep
->from_rtx
== XEXP (x
, 0))
2784 ep
->can_eliminate
= 0;
2786 elimination_effects (XEXP (x
, 0), mem_mode
);
2790 /* If clobbering a register that is the replacement register for an
2791 elimination we still think can be performed, note that it cannot
2792 be performed. Otherwise, we need not be concerned about it. */
2793 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++)
2794 if (ep
->to_rtx
== XEXP (x
, 0))
2795 ep
->can_eliminate
= 0;
2797 elimination_effects (XEXP (x
, 0), mem_mode
);
2801 /* Check for setting a register that we know about. */
2802 if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x
)) == REG
)
2804 /* See if this is setting the replacement register for an
2807 If DEST is the hard frame pointer, we do nothing because we
2808 assume that all assignments to the frame pointer are for
2809 non-local gotos and are being done at a time when they are valid
2810 and do not disturb anything else. Some machines want to
2811 eliminate a fake argument pointer (or even a fake frame pointer)
2812 with either the real frame or the stack pointer. Assignments to
2813 the hard frame pointer must not prevent this elimination. */
2815 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
];
2817 if (ep
->to_rtx
== SET_DEST (x
)
2818 && SET_DEST (x
) != hard_frame_pointer_rtx
)
2820 /* If it is being incremented, adjust the offset. Otherwise,
2821 this elimination can't be done. */
2822 rtx src
= SET_SRC (x
);
2824 if (GET_CODE (src
) == PLUS
2825 && XEXP (src
, 0) == SET_DEST (x
)
2826 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src
, 1)) == CONST_INT
)
2827 ep
->offset
-= INTVAL (XEXP (src
, 1));
2829 ep
->can_eliminate
= 0;
2833 elimination_effects (SET_DEST (x
), 0);
2834 elimination_effects (SET_SRC (x
), 0);
2838 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x
, 0)) == ADDRESSOF
)
2841 /* Our only special processing is to pass the mode of the MEM to our
2843 elimination_effects (XEXP (x
, 0), GET_MODE (x
));
2850 fmt
= GET_RTX_FORMAT (code
);
2851 for (i
= 0; i
< GET_RTX_LENGTH (code
); i
++, fmt
++)
2854 elimination_effects (XEXP (x
, i
), mem_mode
);
2855 else if (*fmt
== 'E')
2856 for (j
= 0; j
< XVECLEN (x
, i
); j
++)
2857 elimination_effects (XVECEXP (x
, i
, j
), mem_mode
);
2861 /* Descend through rtx X and verify that no references to eliminable registers
2862 remain. If any do remain, mark the involved register as not
2866 check_eliminable_occurrences (x
)
2876 code
= GET_CODE (x
);
2878 if (code
== REG
&& REGNO (x
) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
2880 struct elim_table
*ep
;
2882 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++)
2883 if (ep
->from_rtx
== x
&& ep
->can_eliminate
)
2884 ep
->can_eliminate
= 0;
2888 fmt
= GET_RTX_FORMAT (code
);
2889 for (i
= 0; i
< GET_RTX_LENGTH (code
); i
++, fmt
++)
2892 check_eliminable_occurrences (XEXP (x
, i
));
2893 else if (*fmt
== 'E')
2896 for (j
= 0; j
< XVECLEN (x
, i
); j
++)
2897 check_eliminable_occurrences (XVECEXP (x
, i
, j
));
2902 /* Scan INSN and eliminate all eliminable registers in it.
2904 If REPLACE is nonzero, do the replacement destructively. Also
2905 delete the insn as dead it if it is setting an eliminable register.
2907 If REPLACE is zero, do all our allocations in reload_obstack.
2909 If no eliminations were done and this insn doesn't require any elimination
2910 processing (these are not identical conditions: it might be updating sp,
2911 but not referencing fp; this needs to be seen during reload_as_needed so
2912 that the offset between fp and sp can be taken into consideration), zero
2913 is returned. Otherwise, 1 is returned. */
2916 eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn
, replace
)
2920 int icode
= recog_memoized (insn
);
2921 rtx old_body
= PATTERN (insn
);
2922 int insn_is_asm
= asm_noperands (old_body
) >= 0;
2923 rtx old_set
= single_set (insn
);
2927 rtx substed_operand
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
2928 rtx orig_operand
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
2929 struct elim_table
*ep
;
2931 if (! insn_is_asm
&& icode
< 0)
2933 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn
)) == USE
2934 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn
)) == CLOBBER
2935 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn
)) == ADDR_VEC
2936 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn
)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC
2937 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn
)) == ASM_INPUT
)
2942 if (old_set
!= 0 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (old_set
)) == REG
2943 && REGNO (SET_DEST (old_set
)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
2945 /* Check for setting an eliminable register. */
2946 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++)
2947 if (ep
->from_rtx
== SET_DEST (old_set
) && ep
->can_eliminate
)
2949 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2950 /* If this is setting the frame pointer register to the
2951 hardware frame pointer register and this is an elimination
2952 that will be done (tested above), this insn is really
2953 adjusting the frame pointer downward to compensate for
2954 the adjustment done before a nonlocal goto. */
2955 if (ep
->from
== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2956 && ep
->to
== HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
)
2958 rtx base
= SET_SRC (old_set
);
2959 rtx base_insn
= insn
;
2962 while (base
!= ep
->to_rtx
)
2964 rtx prev_insn
, prev_set
;
2966 if (GET_CODE (base
) == PLUS
2967 && GET_CODE (XEXP (base
, 1)) == CONST_INT
)
2969 offset
+= INTVAL (XEXP (base
, 1));
2970 base
= XEXP (base
, 0);
2972 else if ((prev_insn
= prev_nonnote_insn (base_insn
)) != 0
2973 && (prev_set
= single_set (prev_insn
)) != 0
2974 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (prev_set
), base
))
2976 base
= SET_SRC (prev_set
);
2977 base_insn
= prev_insn
;
2983 if (base
== ep
->to_rtx
)
2986 = plus_constant (ep
->to_rtx
, offset
- ep
->offset
);
2988 new_body
= old_body
;
2991 new_body
= copy_insn (old_body
);
2992 if (REG_NOTES (insn
))
2993 REG_NOTES (insn
) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn
));
2995 PATTERN (insn
) = new_body
;
2996 old_set
= single_set (insn
);
2998 /* First see if this insn remains valid when we
2999 make the change. If not, keep the INSN_CODE
3000 the same and let reload fit it up. */
3001 validate_change (insn
, &SET_SRC (old_set
), src
, 1);
3002 validate_change (insn
, &SET_DEST (old_set
),
3004 if (! apply_change_group ())
3006 SET_SRC (old_set
) = src
;
3007 SET_DEST (old_set
) = ep
->to_rtx
;
3016 /* In this case this insn isn't serving a useful purpose. We
3017 will delete it in reload_as_needed once we know that this
3018 elimination is, in fact, being done.
3020 If REPLACE isn't set, we can't delete this insn, but needn't
3021 process it since it won't be used unless something changes. */
3024 delete_dead_insn (insn
);
3032 /* We allow one special case which happens to work on all machines we
3033 currently support: a single set with the source being a PLUS of an
3034 eliminable register and a constant. */
3036 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (old_set
)) == REG
3037 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set
)) == PLUS
3038 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set
), 0)) == REG
3039 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set
), 1)) == CONST_INT
3040 && REGNO (XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set
), 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
3042 rtx reg
= XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set
), 0);
3043 int offset
= INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set
), 1));
3045 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++)
3046 if (ep
->from_rtx
== reg
&& ep
->can_eliminate
)
3048 offset
+= ep
->offset
;
3053 /* We assume here that if we need a PARALLEL with
3054 CLOBBERs for this assignment, we can do with the
3055 MATCH_SCRATCHes that add_clobbers allocates.
3056 There's not much we can do if that doesn't work. */
3057 PATTERN (insn
) = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode
,
3061 INSN_CODE (insn
) = recog (PATTERN (insn
), insn
, &num_clobbers
);
3064 rtvec vec
= rtvec_alloc (num_clobbers
+ 1);
3066 vec
->elem
[0] = PATTERN (insn
);
3067 PATTERN (insn
) = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode
, vec
);
3068 add_clobbers (PATTERN (insn
), INSN_CODE (insn
));
3070 if (INSN_CODE (insn
) < 0)
3075 new_body
= old_body
;
3078 new_body
= copy_insn (old_body
);
3079 if (REG_NOTES (insn
))
3080 REG_NOTES (insn
) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn
));
3082 PATTERN (insn
) = new_body
;
3083 old_set
= single_set (insn
);
3085 XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set
), 0) = ep
->to_rtx
;
3086 XEXP (SET_SRC (old_set
), 1) = GEN_INT (offset
);
3089 /* This can't have an effect on elimination offsets, so skip right
3095 /* Determine the effects of this insn on elimination offsets. */
3096 elimination_effects (old_body
, 0);
3098 /* Eliminate all eliminable registers occurring in operands that
3099 can be handled by reload. */
3100 extract_insn (insn
);
3102 for (i
= 0; i
< recog_data
.n_operands
; i
++)
3104 orig_operand
[i
] = recog_data
.operand
[i
];
3105 substed_operand
[i
] = recog_data
.operand
[i
];
3107 /* For an asm statement, every operand is eliminable. */
3108 if (insn_is_asm
|| insn_data
[icode
].operand
[i
].eliminable
)
3110 /* Check for setting a register that we know about. */
3111 if (recog_data
.operand_type
[i
] != OP_IN
3112 && GET_CODE (orig_operand
[i
]) == REG
)
3114 /* If we are assigning to a register that can be eliminated, it
3115 must be as part of a PARALLEL, since the code above handles
3116 single SETs. We must indicate that we can no longer
3117 eliminate this reg. */
3118 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
];
3120 if (ep
->from_rtx
== orig_operand
[i
] && ep
->can_eliminate
)
3121 ep
->can_eliminate
= 0;
3124 substed_operand
[i
] = eliminate_regs (recog_data
.operand
[i
], 0,
3125 replace
? insn
: NULL_RTX
);
3126 if (substed_operand
[i
] != orig_operand
[i
])
3127 val
= any_changes
= 1;
3128 /* Terminate the search in check_eliminable_occurrences at
3130 *recog_data
.operand_loc
[i
] = 0;
3132 /* If an output operand changed from a REG to a MEM and INSN is an
3133 insn, write a CLOBBER insn. */
3134 if (recog_data
.operand_type
[i
] != OP_IN
3135 && GET_CODE (orig_operand
[i
]) == REG
3136 && GET_CODE (substed_operand
[i
]) == MEM
3138 emit_insn_after (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode
, orig_operand
[i
]),
3143 for (i
= 0; i
< recog_data
.n_dups
; i
++)
3144 *recog_data
.dup_loc
[i
]
3145 = *recog_data
.operand_loc
[(int) recog_data
.dup_num
[i
]];
3147 /* If any eliminable remain, they aren't eliminable anymore. */
3148 check_eliminable_occurrences (old_body
);
3150 /* Substitute the operands; the new values are in the substed_operand
3152 for (i
= 0; i
< recog_data
.n_operands
; i
++)
3153 *recog_data
.operand_loc
[i
] = substed_operand
[i
];
3154 for (i
= 0; i
< recog_data
.n_dups
; i
++)
3155 *recog_data
.dup_loc
[i
] = substed_operand
[(int) recog_data
.dup_num
[i
]];
3157 /* If we are replacing a body that was a (set X (plus Y Z)), try to
3158 re-recognize the insn. We do this in case we had a simple addition
3159 but now can do this as a load-address. This saves an insn in this
3161 If re-recognition fails, the old insn code number will still be used,
3162 and some register operands may have changed into PLUS expressions.
3163 These will be handled by find_reloads by loading them into a register
3168 /* If we aren't replacing things permanently and we changed something,
3169 make another copy to ensure that all the RTL is new. Otherwise
3170 things can go wrong if find_reload swaps commutative operands
3171 and one is inside RTL that has been copied while the other is not. */
3172 new_body
= old_body
;
3175 new_body
= copy_insn (old_body
);
3176 if (REG_NOTES (insn
))
3177 REG_NOTES (insn
) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn
));
3179 PATTERN (insn
) = new_body
;
3181 /* If we had a move insn but now we don't, rerecognize it. This will
3182 cause spurious re-recognition if the old move had a PARALLEL since
3183 the new one still will, but we can't call single_set without
3184 having put NEW_BODY into the insn and the re-recognition won't
3185 hurt in this rare case. */
3186 /* ??? Why this huge if statement - why don't we just rerecognize the
3190 && ((GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set
)) == REG
3191 && (GET_CODE (new_body
) != SET
3192 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (new_body
)) != REG
))
3193 /* If this was a load from or store to memory, compare
3194 the MEM in recog_data.operand to the one in the insn.
3195 If they are not equal, then rerecognize the insn. */
3197 && ((GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set
)) == MEM
3198 && SET_SRC (old_set
) != recog_data
.operand
[1])
3199 || (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (old_set
)) == MEM
3200 && SET_DEST (old_set
) != recog_data
.operand
[0])))
3201 /* If this was an add insn before, rerecognize. */
3202 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set
)) == PLUS
))
3204 int new_icode
= recog (PATTERN (insn
), insn
, 0);
3206 INSN_CODE (insn
) = icode
;
3210 /* Restore the old body. If there were any changes to it, we made a copy
3211 of it while the changes were still in place, so we'll correctly return
3212 a modified insn below. */
3215 /* Restore the old body. */
3216 for (i
= 0; i
< recog_data
.n_operands
; i
++)
3217 *recog_data
.operand_loc
[i
] = orig_operand
[i
];
3218 for (i
= 0; i
< recog_data
.n_dups
; i
++)
3219 *recog_data
.dup_loc
[i
] = orig_operand
[(int) recog_data
.dup_num
[i
]];
3222 /* Update all elimination pairs to reflect the status after the current
3223 insn. The changes we make were determined by the earlier call to
3224 elimination_effects.
3226 We also detect a cases where register elimination cannot be done,
3227 namely, if a register would be both changed and referenced outside a MEM
3228 in the resulting insn since such an insn is often undefined and, even if
3229 not, we cannot know what meaning will be given to it. Note that it is
3230 valid to have a register used in an address in an insn that changes it
3231 (presumably with a pre- or post-increment or decrement).
3233 If anything changes, return nonzero. */
3235 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++)
3237 if (ep
->previous_offset
!= ep
->offset
&& ep
->ref_outside_mem
)
3238 ep
->can_eliminate
= 0;
3240 ep
->ref_outside_mem
= 0;
3242 if (ep
->previous_offset
!= ep
->offset
)
3247 /* If we changed something, perform elimination in REG_NOTES. This is
3248 needed even when REPLACE is zero because a REG_DEAD note might refer
3249 to a register that we eliminate and could cause a different number
3250 of spill registers to be needed in the final reload pass than in
3252 if (val
&& REG_NOTES (insn
) != 0)
3253 REG_NOTES (insn
) = eliminate_regs (REG_NOTES (insn
), 0, REG_NOTES (insn
));
3258 /* Loop through all elimination pairs.
3259 Recalculate the number not at initial offset.
3261 Compute the maximum offset (minimum offset if the stack does not
3262 grow downward) for each elimination pair. */
3265 update_eliminable_offsets ()
3267 struct elim_table
*ep
;
3269 num_not_at_initial_offset
= 0;
3270 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++)
3272 ep
->previous_offset
= ep
->offset
;
3273 if (ep
->can_eliminate
&& ep
->offset
!= ep
->initial_offset
)
3274 num_not_at_initial_offset
++;
3278 /* Given X, a SET or CLOBBER of DEST, if DEST is the target of a register
3279 replacement we currently believe is valid, mark it as not eliminable if X
3280 modifies DEST in any way other than by adding a constant integer to it.
3282 If DEST is the frame pointer, we do nothing because we assume that
3283 all assignments to the hard frame pointer are nonlocal gotos and are being
3284 done at a time when they are valid and do not disturb anything else.
3285 Some machines want to eliminate a fake argument pointer with either the
3286 frame or stack pointer. Assignments to the hard frame pointer must not
3287 prevent this elimination.
3289 Called via note_stores from reload before starting its passes to scan
3290 the insns of the function. */
3293 mark_not_eliminable (dest
, x
, data
)
3296 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
;
3300 /* A SUBREG of a hard register here is just changing its mode. We should
3301 not see a SUBREG of an eliminable hard register, but check just in
3303 if (GET_CODE (dest
) == SUBREG
)
3304 dest
= SUBREG_REG (dest
);
3306 if (dest
== hard_frame_pointer_rtx
)
3309 for (i
= 0; i
< NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
; i
++)
3310 if (reg_eliminate
[i
].can_eliminate
&& dest
== reg_eliminate
[i
].to_rtx
3311 && (GET_CODE (x
) != SET
3312 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x
)) != PLUS
3313 || XEXP (SET_SRC (x
), 0) != dest
3314 || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (x
), 1)) != CONST_INT
))
3316 reg_eliminate
[i
].can_eliminate_previous
3317 = reg_eliminate
[i
].can_eliminate
= 0;
3322 /* Verify that the initial elimination offsets did not change since the
3323 last call to set_initial_elim_offsets. This is used to catch cases
3324 where something illegal happened during reload_as_needed that could
3325 cause incorrect code to be generated if we did not check for it. */
3328 verify_initial_elim_offsets ()
3332 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3333 struct elim_table
*ep
;
3335 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++)
3337 INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (ep
->from
, ep
->to
, t
);
3338 if (t
!= ep
->initial_offset
)
3342 INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (t
);
3343 if (t
!= reg_eliminate
[0].initial_offset
)
3348 /* Reset all offsets on eliminable registers to their initial values. */
3351 set_initial_elim_offsets ()
3353 struct elim_table
*ep
= reg_eliminate
;
3355 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3356 for (; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++)
3358 INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (ep
->from
, ep
->to
, ep
->initial_offset
);
3359 ep
->previous_offset
= ep
->offset
= ep
->initial_offset
;
3362 INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (ep
->initial_offset
);
3363 ep
->previous_offset
= ep
->offset
= ep
->initial_offset
;
3366 num_not_at_initial_offset
= 0;
3369 /* Initialize the known label offsets.
3370 Set a known offset for each forced label to be at the initial offset
3371 of each elimination. We do this because we assume that all
3372 computed jumps occur from a location where each elimination is
3373 at its initial offset.
3374 For all other labels, show that we don't know the offsets. */
3377 set_initial_label_offsets ()
3380 memset ((char *) &offsets_known_at
[get_first_label_num ()], 0, num_labels
);
3382 for (x
= forced_labels
; x
; x
= XEXP (x
, 1))
3384 set_label_offsets (XEXP (x
, 0), NULL_RTX
, 1);
3387 /* Set all elimination offsets to the known values for the code label given
3391 set_offsets_for_label (insn
)
3395 int label_nr
= CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn
);
3396 struct elim_table
*ep
;
3398 num_not_at_initial_offset
= 0;
3399 for (i
= 0, ep
= reg_eliminate
; i
< NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
; ep
++, i
++)
3401 ep
->offset
= ep
->previous_offset
= offsets_at
[label_nr
][i
];
3402 if (ep
->can_eliminate
&& ep
->offset
!= ep
->initial_offset
)
3403 num_not_at_initial_offset
++;
3407 /* See if anything that happened changes which eliminations are valid.
3408 For example, on the Sparc, whether or not the frame pointer can
3409 be eliminated can depend on what registers have been used. We need
3410 not check some conditions again (such as flag_omit_frame_pointer)
3411 since they can't have changed. */
3414 update_eliminables (pset
)
3417 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3418 int previous_frame_pointer_needed
= frame_pointer_needed
;
3420 struct elim_table
*ep
;
3422 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++)
3423 if ((ep
->from
== HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
&& FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
)
3424 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3425 || ! CAN_ELIMINATE (ep
->from
, ep
->to
)
3428 ep
->can_eliminate
= 0;
3430 /* Look for the case where we have discovered that we can't replace
3431 register A with register B and that means that we will now be
3432 trying to replace register A with register C. This means we can
3433 no longer replace register C with register B and we need to disable
3434 such an elimination, if it exists. This occurs often with A == ap,
3435 B == sp, and C == fp. */
3437 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++)
3439 struct elim_table
*op
;
3442 if (! ep
->can_eliminate
&& ep
->can_eliminate_previous
)
3444 /* Find the current elimination for ep->from, if there is a
3446 for (op
= reg_eliminate
;
3447 op
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; op
++)
3448 if (op
->from
== ep
->from
&& op
->can_eliminate
)
3454 /* See if there is an elimination of NEW_TO -> EP->TO. If so,
3456 for (op
= reg_eliminate
;
3457 op
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; op
++)
3458 if (op
->from
== new_to
&& op
->to
== ep
->to
)
3459 op
->can_eliminate
= 0;
3463 /* See if any registers that we thought we could eliminate the previous
3464 time are no longer eliminable. If so, something has changed and we
3465 must spill the register. Also, recompute the number of eliminable
3466 registers and see if the frame pointer is needed; it is if there is
3467 no elimination of the frame pointer that we can perform. */
3469 frame_pointer_needed
= 1;
3470 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++)
3472 if (ep
->can_eliminate
&& ep
->from
== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3473 && ep
->to
!= HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
)
3474 frame_pointer_needed
= 0;
3476 if (! ep
->can_eliminate
&& ep
->can_eliminate_previous
)
3478 ep
->can_eliminate_previous
= 0;
3479 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*pset
, ep
->from
);
3484 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3485 /* If we didn't need a frame pointer last time, but we do now, spill
3486 the hard frame pointer. */
3487 if (frame_pointer_needed
&& ! previous_frame_pointer_needed
)
3488 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*pset
, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
);
3492 /* Initialize the table of registers to eliminate. */
3497 struct elim_table
*ep
;
3498 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3499 const struct elim_table_1
*ep1
;
3503 reg_eliminate
= (struct elim_table
*)
3504 xcalloc (sizeof (struct elim_table
), NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
);
3506 /* Does this function require a frame pointer? */
3508 frame_pointer_needed
= (! flag_omit_frame_pointer
3509 #ifdef EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
3510 /* ?? If EXIT_IGNORE_STACK is set, we will not save
3511 and restore sp for alloca. So we can't eliminate
3512 the frame pointer in that case. At some point,
3513 we should improve this by emitting the
3514 sp-adjusting insns for this case. */
3515 || (current_function_calls_alloca
3516 && EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
)
3518 || FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
);
3522 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3523 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
, ep1
= reg_eliminate_1
;
3524 ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++, ep1
++)
3526 ep
->from
= ep1
->from
;
3528 ep
->can_eliminate
= ep
->can_eliminate_previous
3529 = (CAN_ELIMINATE (ep
->from
, ep
->to
)
3530 && ! (ep
->to
== STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
&& frame_pointer_needed
));
3533 reg_eliminate
[0].from
= reg_eliminate_1
[0].from
;
3534 reg_eliminate
[0].to
= reg_eliminate_1
[0].to
;
3535 reg_eliminate
[0].can_eliminate
= reg_eliminate
[0].can_eliminate_previous
3536 = ! frame_pointer_needed
;
3539 /* Count the number of eliminable registers and build the FROM and TO
3540 REG rtx's. Note that code in gen_rtx will cause, e.g.,
3541 gen_rtx (REG, Pmode, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM) to equal stack_pointer_rtx.
3542 We depend on this. */
3543 for (ep
= reg_eliminate
; ep
< ®_eliminate
[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS
]; ep
++)
3545 num_eliminable
+= ep
->can_eliminate
;
3546 ep
->from_rtx
= gen_rtx_REG (Pmode
, ep
->from
);
3547 ep
->to_rtx
= gen_rtx_REG (Pmode
, ep
->to
);
3551 /* Kick all pseudos out of hard register REGNO.
3553 If CANT_ELIMINATE is nonzero, it means that we are doing this spill
3554 because we found we can't eliminate some register. In the case, no pseudos
3555 are allowed to be in the register, even if they are only in a block that
3556 doesn't require spill registers, unlike the case when we are spilling this
3557 hard reg to produce another spill register.
3559 Return nonzero if any pseudos needed to be kicked out. */
3562 spill_hard_reg (regno
, cant_eliminate
)
3570 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs_global
, regno
);
3571 regs_ever_live
[regno
] = 1;
3574 /* Spill every pseudo reg that was allocated to this reg
3575 or to something that overlaps this reg. */
3577 for (i
= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
< max_regno
; i
++)
3578 if (reg_renumber
[i
] >= 0
3579 && (unsigned int) reg_renumber
[i
] <= regno
3580 && ((unsigned int) reg_renumber
[i
]
3581 + HARD_REGNO_NREGS ((unsigned int) reg_renumber
[i
],
3582 PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (i
))
3584 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos
, i
);
3587 /* I'm getting weird preprocessor errors if I use IOR_HARD_REG_SET
3588 from within EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET. Hence this awkwardness. */
3591 ior_hard_reg_set (set1
, set2
)
3592 HARD_REG_SET
*set1
, *set2
;
3594 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (*set1
, *set2
);
3597 /* After find_reload_regs has been run for all insn that need reloads,
3598 and/or spill_hard_regs was called, this function is used to actually
3599 spill pseudo registers and try to reallocate them. It also sets up the
3600 spill_regs array for use by choose_reload_regs. */
3603 finish_spills (global
)
3606 struct insn_chain
*chain
;
3607 int something_changed
= 0;
3610 /* Build the spill_regs array for the function. */
3611 /* If there are some registers still to eliminate and one of the spill regs
3612 wasn't ever used before, additional stack space may have to be
3613 allocated to store this register. Thus, we may have changed the offset
3614 between the stack and frame pointers, so mark that something has changed.
3616 One might think that we need only set VAL to 1 if this is a call-used
3617 register. However, the set of registers that must be saved by the
3618 prologue is not identical to the call-used set. For example, the
3619 register used by the call insn for the return PC is a call-used register,
3620 but must be saved by the prologue. */
3623 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
3624 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs
, i
))
3626 spill_reg_order
[i
] = n_spills
;
3627 spill_regs
[n_spills
++] = i
;
3628 if (num_eliminable
&& ! regs_ever_live
[i
])
3629 something_changed
= 1;
3630 regs_ever_live
[i
] = 1;
3633 spill_reg_order
[i
] = -1;
3635 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
3636 (&spilled_pseudos
, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
, i
,
3638 /* Record the current hard register the pseudo is allocated to in
3639 pseudo_previous_regs so we avoid reallocating it to the same
3640 hard reg in a later pass. */
3641 if (reg_renumber
[i
] < 0)
3644 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (pseudo_previous_regs
[i
], reg_renumber
[i
]);
3645 /* Mark it as no longer having a hard register home. */
3646 reg_renumber
[i
] = -1;
3647 /* We will need to scan everything again. */
3648 something_changed
= 1;
3651 /* Retry global register allocation if possible. */
3654 memset ((char *) pseudo_forbidden_regs
, 0, max_regno
* sizeof (HARD_REG_SET
));
3655 /* For every insn that needs reloads, set the registers used as spill
3656 regs in pseudo_forbidden_regs for every pseudo live across the
3658 for (chain
= insns_need_reload
; chain
; chain
= chain
->next_need_reload
)
3660 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
3661 (&chain
->live_throughout
, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
, i
,
3663 ior_hard_reg_set (pseudo_forbidden_regs
+ i
,
3664 &chain
->used_spill_regs
);
3666 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
3667 (&chain
->dead_or_set
, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
, i
,
3669 ior_hard_reg_set (pseudo_forbidden_regs
+ i
,
3670 &chain
->used_spill_regs
);
3674 /* Retry allocating the spilled pseudos. For each reg, merge the
3675 various reg sets that indicate which hard regs can't be used,
3676 and call retry_global_alloc.
3677 We change spill_pseudos here to only contain pseudos that did not
3678 get a new hard register. */
3679 for (i
= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
< max_regno
; i
++)
3680 if (reg_old_renumber
[i
] != reg_renumber
[i
])
3682 HARD_REG_SET forbidden
;
3683 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden
, bad_spill_regs_global
);
3684 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden
, pseudo_forbidden_regs
[i
]);
3685 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden
, pseudo_previous_regs
[i
]);
3686 retry_global_alloc (i
, forbidden
);
3687 if (reg_renumber
[i
] >= 0)
3688 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos
, i
);
3692 /* Fix up the register information in the insn chain.
3693 This involves deleting those of the spilled pseudos which did not get
3694 a new hard register home from the live_{before,after} sets. */
3695 for (chain
= reload_insn_chain
; chain
; chain
= chain
->next
)
3697 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos
;
3698 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos2
;
3700 AND_COMPL_REG_SET (&chain
->live_throughout
, &spilled_pseudos
);
3701 AND_COMPL_REG_SET (&chain
->dead_or_set
, &spilled_pseudos
);
3703 /* Mark any unallocated hard regs as available for spills. That
3704 makes inheritance work somewhat better. */
3705 if (chain
->need_reload
)
3707 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos
, &chain
->live_throughout
);
3708 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2
, &chain
->dead_or_set
);
3709 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos
, used_by_pseudos2
);
3711 /* Save the old value for the sanity test below. */
3712 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2
, chain
->used_spill_regs
);
3714 compute_use_by_pseudos (&used_by_pseudos
, &chain
->live_throughout
);
3715 compute_use_by_pseudos (&used_by_pseudos
, &chain
->dead_or_set
);
3716 COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (chain
->used_spill_regs
, used_by_pseudos
);
3717 AND_HARD_REG_SET (chain
->used_spill_regs
, used_spill_regs
);
3719 /* Make sure we only enlarge the set. */
3720 GO_IF_HARD_REG_SUBSET (used_by_pseudos2
, chain
->used_spill_regs
, ok
);
3726 /* Let alter_reg modify the reg rtx's for the modified pseudos. */
3727 for (i
= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
< max_regno
; i
++)
3729 int regno
= reg_renumber
[i
];
3730 if (reg_old_renumber
[i
] == regno
)
3733 alter_reg (i
, reg_old_renumber
[i
]);
3734 reg_old_renumber
[i
] = regno
;
3738 fprintf (rtl_dump_file
, " Register %d now on stack.\n\n", i
);
3740 fprintf (rtl_dump_file
, " Register %d now in %d.\n\n",
3741 i
, reg_renumber
[i
]);
3745 return something_changed
;
3748 /* Find all paradoxical subregs within X and update reg_max_ref_width.
3749 Also mark any hard registers used to store user variables as
3750 forbidden from being used for spill registers. */
3753 scan_paradoxical_subregs (x
)
3758 enum rtx_code code
= GET_CODE (x
);
3764 if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
&& REGNO (x
) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
3765 && REG_USERVAR_P (x
))
3766 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs_global
, REGNO (x
));
3775 case CONST_VECTOR
: /* shouldn't happen, but just in case. */
3783 if (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x
)) == REG
3784 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x
)) > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x
))))
3785 reg_max_ref_width
[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x
))]
3786 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x
));
3793 fmt
= GET_RTX_FORMAT (code
);
3794 for (i
= GET_RTX_LENGTH (code
) - 1; i
>= 0; i
--)
3797 scan_paradoxical_subregs (XEXP (x
, i
));
3798 else if (fmt
[i
] == 'E')
3801 for (j
= XVECLEN (x
, i
) - 1; j
>= 0; j
--)
3802 scan_paradoxical_subregs (XVECEXP (x
, i
, j
));
3807 /* Reload pseudo-registers into hard regs around each insn as needed.
3808 Additional register load insns are output before the insn that needs it
3809 and perhaps store insns after insns that modify the reloaded pseudo reg.
3811 reg_last_reload_reg and reg_reloaded_contents keep track of
3812 which registers are already available in reload registers.
3813 We update these for the reloads that we perform,
3814 as the insns are scanned. */
3817 reload_as_needed (live_known
)
3820 struct insn_chain
*chain
;
3821 #if defined (AUTO_INC_DEC)
3826 memset ((char *) spill_reg_rtx
, 0, sizeof spill_reg_rtx
);
3827 memset ((char *) spill_reg_store
, 0, sizeof spill_reg_store
);
3828 reg_last_reload_reg
= (rtx
*) xcalloc (max_regno
, sizeof (rtx
));
3829 reg_has_output_reload
= (char *) xmalloc (max_regno
);
3830 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid
);
3832 set_initial_elim_offsets ();
3834 for (chain
= reload_insn_chain
; chain
; chain
= chain
->next
)
3837 rtx insn
= chain
->insn
;
3838 rtx old_next
= NEXT_INSN (insn
);
3840 /* If we pass a label, copy the offsets from the label information
3841 into the current offsets of each elimination. */
3842 if (GET_CODE (insn
) == CODE_LABEL
)
3843 set_offsets_for_label (insn
);
3845 else if (INSN_P (insn
))
3847 rtx oldpat
= PATTERN (insn
);
3849 /* If this is a USE and CLOBBER of a MEM, ensure that any
3850 references to eliminable registers have been removed. */
3852 if ((GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn
)) == USE
3853 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn
)) == CLOBBER
)
3854 && GET_CODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn
), 0)) == MEM
)
3855 XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn
), 0), 0)
3856 = eliminate_regs (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn
), 0), 0),
3857 GET_MODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn
), 0)),
3860 /* If we need to do register elimination processing, do so.
3861 This might delete the insn, in which case we are done. */
3862 if ((num_eliminable
|| num_eliminable_invariants
) && chain
->need_elim
)
3864 eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn
, 1);
3865 if (GET_CODE (insn
) == NOTE
)
3867 update_eliminable_offsets ();
3872 /* If need_elim is nonzero but need_reload is zero, one might think
3873 that we could simply set n_reloads to 0. However, find_reloads
3874 could have done some manipulation of the insn (such as swapping
3875 commutative operands), and these manipulations are lost during
3876 the first pass for every insn that needs register elimination.
3877 So the actions of find_reloads must be redone here. */
3879 if (! chain
->need_elim
&& ! chain
->need_reload
3880 && ! chain
->need_operand_change
)
3882 /* First find the pseudo regs that must be reloaded for this insn.
3883 This info is returned in the tables reload_... (see reload.h).
3884 Also modify the body of INSN by substituting RELOAD
3885 rtx's for those pseudo regs. */
3888 memset (reg_has_output_reload
, 0, max_regno
);
3889 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_is_output_reload
);
3891 find_reloads (insn
, 1, spill_indirect_levels
, live_known
,
3897 rtx next
= NEXT_INSN (insn
);
3900 prev
= PREV_INSN (insn
);
3902 /* Now compute which reload regs to reload them into. Perhaps
3903 reusing reload regs from previous insns, or else output
3904 load insns to reload them. Maybe output store insns too.
3905 Record the choices of reload reg in reload_reg_rtx. */
3906 choose_reload_regs (chain
);
3908 /* Merge any reloads that we didn't combine for fear of
3909 increasing the number of spill registers needed but now
3910 discover can be safely merged. */
3911 if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
)
3912 merge_assigned_reloads (insn
);
3914 /* Generate the insns to reload operands into or out of
3915 their reload regs. */
3916 emit_reload_insns (chain
);
3918 /* Substitute the chosen reload regs from reload_reg_rtx
3919 into the insn's body (or perhaps into the bodies of other
3920 load and store insn that we just made for reloading
3921 and that we moved the structure into). */
3922 subst_reloads (insn
);
3924 /* If this was an ASM, make sure that all the reload insns
3925 we have generated are valid. If not, give an error
3928 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn
)) >= 0)
3929 for (p
= NEXT_INSN (prev
); p
!= next
; p
= NEXT_INSN (p
))
3930 if (p
!= insn
&& INSN_P (p
)
3931 && (recog_memoized (p
) < 0
3932 || (extract_insn (p
), ! constrain_operands (1))))
3934 error_for_asm (insn
,
3935 "`asm' operand requires impossible reload");
3940 if (num_eliminable
&& chain
->need_elim
)
3941 update_eliminable_offsets ();
3943 /* Any previously reloaded spilled pseudo reg, stored in this insn,
3944 is no longer validly lying around to save a future reload.
3945 Note that this does not detect pseudos that were reloaded
3946 for this insn in order to be stored in
3947 (obeying register constraints). That is correct; such reload
3948 registers ARE still valid. */
3949 note_stores (oldpat
, forget_old_reloads_1
, NULL
);
3951 /* There may have been CLOBBER insns placed after INSN. So scan
3952 between INSN and NEXT and use them to forget old reloads. */
3953 for (x
= NEXT_INSN (insn
); x
!= old_next
; x
= NEXT_INSN (x
))
3954 if (GET_CODE (x
) == INSN
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (x
)) == CLOBBER
)
3955 note_stores (PATTERN (x
), forget_old_reloads_1
, NULL
);
3958 /* Likewise for regs altered by auto-increment in this insn.
3959 REG_INC notes have been changed by reloading:
3960 find_reloads_address_1 records substitutions for them,
3961 which have been performed by subst_reloads above. */
3962 for (i
= n_reloads
- 1; i
>= 0; i
--)
3964 rtx in_reg
= rld
[i
].in_reg
;
3967 enum rtx_code code
= GET_CODE (in_reg
);
3968 /* PRE_INC / PRE_DEC will have the reload register ending up
3969 with the same value as the stack slot, but that doesn't
3970 hold true for POST_INC / POST_DEC. Either we have to
3971 convert the memory access to a true POST_INC / POST_DEC,
3972 or we can't use the reload register for inheritance. */
3973 if ((code
== POST_INC
|| code
== POST_DEC
)
3974 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid
,
3975 REGNO (rld
[i
].reg_rtx
))
3976 /* Make sure it is the inc/dec pseudo, and not
3977 some other (e.g. output operand) pseudo. */
3978 && (reg_reloaded_contents
[REGNO (rld
[i
].reg_rtx
)]
3979 == REGNO (XEXP (in_reg
, 0))))
3982 rtx reload_reg
= rld
[i
].reg_rtx
;
3983 enum machine_mode mode
= GET_MODE (reload_reg
);
3987 for (p
= PREV_INSN (old_next
); p
!= prev
; p
= PREV_INSN (p
))
3989 /* We really want to ignore REG_INC notes here, so
3990 use PATTERN (p) as argument to reg_set_p . */
3991 if (reg_set_p (reload_reg
, PATTERN (p
)))
3993 n
= count_occurrences (PATTERN (p
), reload_reg
, 0);
3998 n
= validate_replace_rtx (reload_reg
,
3999 gen_rtx (code
, mode
,
4003 /* We must also verify that the constraints
4004 are met after the replacement. */
4007 n
= constrain_operands (1);
4011 /* If the constraints were not met, then
4012 undo the replacement. */
4015 validate_replace_rtx (gen_rtx (code
, mode
,
4027 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_INC
, reload_reg
,
4029 /* Mark this as having an output reload so that the
4030 REG_INC processing code below won't invalidate
4031 the reload for inheritance. */
4032 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload
,
4033 REGNO (reload_reg
));
4034 reg_has_output_reload
[REGNO (XEXP (in_reg
, 0))] = 1;
4037 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (in_reg
, 0), NULL_RTX
,
4040 else if ((code
== PRE_INC
|| code
== PRE_DEC
)
4041 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid
,
4042 REGNO (rld
[i
].reg_rtx
))
4043 /* Make sure it is the inc/dec pseudo, and not
4044 some other (e.g. output operand) pseudo. */
4045 && (reg_reloaded_contents
[REGNO (rld
[i
].reg_rtx
)]
4046 == REGNO (XEXP (in_reg
, 0))))
4048 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload
,
4049 REGNO (rld
[i
].reg_rtx
));
4050 reg_has_output_reload
[REGNO (XEXP (in_reg
, 0))] = 1;
4054 /* If a pseudo that got a hard register is auto-incremented,
4055 we must purge records of copying it into pseudos without
4057 for (x
= REG_NOTES (insn
); x
; x
= XEXP (x
, 1))
4058 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (x
) == REG_INC
)
4060 /* See if this pseudo reg was reloaded in this insn.
4061 If so, its last-reload info is still valid
4062 because it is based on this insn's reload. */
4063 for (i
= 0; i
< n_reloads
; i
++)
4064 if (rld
[i
].out
== XEXP (x
, 0))
4068 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (x
, 0), NULL_RTX
, NULL
);
4072 /* A reload reg's contents are unknown after a label. */
4073 if (GET_CODE (insn
) == CODE_LABEL
)
4074 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid
);
4076 /* Don't assume a reload reg is still good after a call insn
4077 if it is a call-used reg. */
4078 else if (GET_CODE (insn
) == CALL_INSN
)
4079 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid
, call_used_reg_set
);
4083 free (reg_last_reload_reg
);
4084 free (reg_has_output_reload
);
4087 /* Discard all record of any value reloaded from X,
4088 or reloaded in X from someplace else;
4089 unless X is an output reload reg of the current insn.
4091 X may be a hard reg (the reload reg)
4092 or it may be a pseudo reg that was reloaded from. */
4095 forget_old_reloads_1 (x
, ignored
, data
)
4097 rtx ignored ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
;
4098 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
;
4103 /* note_stores does give us subregs of hard regs,
4104 subreg_regno_offset will abort if it is not a hard reg. */
4105 while (GET_CODE (x
) == SUBREG
)
4107 /* We ignore the subreg offset when calculating the regno,
4108 because we are using the entire underlying hard register
4113 if (GET_CODE (x
) != REG
)
4118 if (regno
>= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
4124 nr
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno
, GET_MODE (x
));
4125 /* Storing into a spilled-reg invalidates its contents.
4126 This can happen if a block-local pseudo is allocated to that reg
4127 and it wasn't spilled because this block's total need is 0.
4128 Then some insn might have an optional reload and use this reg. */
4129 for (i
= 0; i
< nr
; i
++)
4130 /* But don't do this if the reg actually serves as an output
4131 reload reg in the current instruction. */
4133 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload
, regno
+ i
))
4135 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid
, regno
+ i
);
4136 spill_reg_store
[regno
+ i
] = 0;
4140 /* Since value of X has changed,
4141 forget any value previously copied from it. */
4144 /* But don't forget a copy if this is the output reload
4145 that establishes the copy's validity. */
4146 if (n_reloads
== 0 || reg_has_output_reload
[regno
+ nr
] == 0)
4147 reg_last_reload_reg
[regno
+ nr
] = 0;
4150 /* The following HARD_REG_SETs indicate when each hard register is
4151 used for a reload of various parts of the current insn. */
4153 /* If reg is unavailable for all reloads. */
4154 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_unavailable
;
4155 /* If reg is in use as a reload reg for a RELOAD_OTHER reload. */
4156 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used
;
4157 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4158 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_input_addr
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
4159 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4160 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
4161 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4162 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_output_addr
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
4163 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4164 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
4165 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reload for operand I. */
4166 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_input
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
4167 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reload for operand I. */
4168 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_output
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
4169 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reload. */
4170 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_op_addr
;
4171 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reload. */
4172 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload
;
4173 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INSN reload. */
4174 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_insn
;
4175 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reload. */
4176 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_other_addr
;
4178 /* If reg is in use as a reload reg for any sort of reload. */
4179 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_at_all
;
4181 /* If reg is use as an inherited reload. We just mark the first register
4183 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_for_inherit
;
4185 /* Records which hard regs are used in any way, either as explicit use or
4186 by being allocated to a pseudo during any point of the current insn. */
4187 static HARD_REG_SET reg_used_in_insn
;
4189 /* Mark reg REGNO as in use for a reload of the sort spec'd by OPNUM and
4190 TYPE. MODE is used to indicate how many consecutive regs are
4194 mark_reload_reg_in_use (regno
, opnum
, type
, mode
)
4197 enum reload_type type
;
4198 enum machine_mode mode
;
4200 unsigned int nregs
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno
, mode
);
4203 for (i
= regno
; i
< nregs
+ regno
; i
++)
4208 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used
, i
);
4211 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
:
4212 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr
[opnum
], i
);
4215 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
:
4216 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr
[opnum
], i
);
4219 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
:
4220 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr
[opnum
], i
);
4223 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS
:
4224 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr
[opnum
], i
);
4227 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
:
4228 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr
, i
);
4231 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
:
4232 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload
, i
);
4235 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
:
4236 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr
, i
);
4239 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
:
4240 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input
[opnum
], i
);
4243 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
:
4244 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output
[opnum
], i
);
4247 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN
:
4248 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn
, i
);
4252 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all
, i
);
4256 /* Similarly, but show REGNO is no longer in use for a reload. */
4259 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno
, opnum
, type
, mode
)
4262 enum reload_type type
;
4263 enum machine_mode mode
;
4265 unsigned int nregs
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno
, mode
);
4266 unsigned int start_regno
, end_regno
, r
;
4268 /* A complication is that for some reload types, inheritance might
4269 allow multiple reloads of the same types to share a reload register.
4270 We set check_opnum if we have to check only reloads with the same
4271 operand number, and check_any if we have to check all reloads. */
4272 int check_opnum
= 0;
4274 HARD_REG_SET
*used_in_set
;
4279 used_in_set
= &reload_reg_used
;
4282 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
:
4283 used_in_set
= &reload_reg_used_in_input_addr
[opnum
];
4286 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
:
4288 used_in_set
= &reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr
[opnum
];
4291 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
:
4292 used_in_set
= &reload_reg_used_in_output_addr
[opnum
];
4295 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS
:
4297 used_in_set
= &reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr
[opnum
];
4300 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
:
4301 used_in_set
= &reload_reg_used_in_op_addr
;
4304 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
:
4306 used_in_set
= &reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload
;
4309 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
:
4310 used_in_set
= &reload_reg_used_in_other_addr
;
4314 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
:
4315 used_in_set
= &reload_reg_used_in_input
[opnum
];
4318 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
:
4319 used_in_set
= &reload_reg_used_in_output
[opnum
];
4322 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN
:
4323 used_in_set
= &reload_reg_used_in_insn
;
4328 /* We resolve conflicts with remaining reloads of the same type by
4329 excluding the intervals of of reload registers by them from the
4330 interval of freed reload registers. Since we only keep track of
4331 one set of interval bounds, we might have to exclude somewhat
4332 more than what would be necessary if we used a HARD_REG_SET here.
4333 But this should only happen very infrequently, so there should
4334 be no reason to worry about it. */
4336 start_regno
= regno
;
4337 end_regno
= regno
+ nregs
;
4338 if (check_opnum
|| check_any
)
4340 for (i
= n_reloads
- 1; i
>= 0; i
--)
4342 if (rld
[i
].when_needed
== type
4343 && (check_any
|| rld
[i
].opnum
== opnum
)
4346 unsigned int conflict_start
= true_regnum (rld
[i
].reg_rtx
);
4347 unsigned int conflict_end
4349 + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (conflict_start
, rld
[i
].mode
));
4351 /* If there is an overlap with the first to-be-freed register,
4352 adjust the interval start. */
4353 if (conflict_start
<= start_regno
&& conflict_end
> start_regno
)
4354 start_regno
= conflict_end
;
4355 /* Otherwise, if there is a conflict with one of the other
4356 to-be-freed registers, adjust the interval end. */
4357 if (conflict_start
> start_regno
&& conflict_start
< end_regno
)
4358 end_regno
= conflict_start
;
4363 for (r
= start_regno
; r
< end_regno
; r
++)
4364 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (*used_in_set
, r
);
4367 /* 1 if reg REGNO is free as a reload reg for a reload of the sort
4368 specified by OPNUM and TYPE. */
4371 reload_reg_free_p (regno
, opnum
, type
)
4374 enum reload_type type
;
4378 /* In use for a RELOAD_OTHER means it's not available for anything. */
4379 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used
, regno
)
4380 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable
, regno
))
4386 /* In use for anything means we can't use it for RELOAD_OTHER. */
4387 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr
, regno
)
4388 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr
, regno
)
4389 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn
, regno
))
4392 for (i
= 0; i
< reload_n_operands
; i
++)
4393 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr
[i
], regno
)
4394 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr
[i
], regno
)
4395 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr
[i
], regno
)
4396 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr
[i
], regno
)
4397 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input
[i
], regno
)
4398 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output
[i
], regno
))
4403 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
:
4404 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn
, regno
)
4405 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr
, regno
))
4408 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload
, regno
))
4411 /* If it is used for some other input, can't use it. */
4412 for (i
= 0; i
< reload_n_operands
; i
++)
4413 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input
[i
], regno
))
4416 /* If it is used in a later operand's address, can't use it. */
4417 for (i
= opnum
+ 1; i
< reload_n_operands
; i
++)
4418 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr
[i
], regno
)
4419 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr
[i
], regno
))
4424 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
:
4425 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an input address for this
4426 operand or used as an input in an earlier one. */
4427 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr
[opnum
], regno
)
4428 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr
[opnum
], regno
))
4431 for (i
= 0; i
< opnum
; i
++)
4432 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input
[i
], regno
))
4437 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
:
4438 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an input address
4439 for this operand or used as an input in an earlier
4441 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr
[opnum
], regno
))
4444 for (i
= 0; i
< opnum
; i
++)
4445 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input
[i
], regno
))
4450 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
:
4451 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an output address for this
4452 operand or used as an output in this or a later operand. Note
4453 that multiple output operands are emitted in reverse order, so
4454 the conflicting ones are those with lower indices. */
4455 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr
[opnum
], regno
))
4458 for (i
= 0; i
<= opnum
; i
++)
4459 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output
[i
], regno
))
4464 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS
:
4465 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an output address
4466 for this operand or used as an output in this or a
4467 later operand. Note that multiple output operands are
4468 emitted in reverse order, so the conflicting ones are
4469 those with lower indices. */
4470 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr
[opnum
], regno
))
4473 for (i
= 0; i
<= opnum
; i
++)
4474 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output
[i
], regno
))
4479 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
:
4480 for (i
= 0; i
< reload_n_operands
; i
++)
4481 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input
[i
], regno
))
4484 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn
, regno
)
4485 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr
, regno
));
4487 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
:
4488 for (i
= 0; i
< reload_n_operands
; i
++)
4489 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input
[i
], regno
))
4492 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload
, regno
));
4494 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
:
4495 /* This cannot share a register with RELOAD_FOR_INSN reloads, other
4496 outputs, or an operand address for this or an earlier output.
4497 Note that multiple output operands are emitted in reverse order,
4498 so the conflicting ones are those with higher indices. */
4499 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn
, regno
))
4502 for (i
= 0; i
< reload_n_operands
; i
++)
4503 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output
[i
], regno
))
4506 for (i
= opnum
; i
< reload_n_operands
; i
++)
4507 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr
[i
], regno
)
4508 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr
[i
], regno
))
4513 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN
:
4514 for (i
= 0; i
< reload_n_operands
; i
++)
4515 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input
[i
], regno
)
4516 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output
[i
], regno
))
4519 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn
, regno
)
4520 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr
, regno
));
4522 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
:
4523 return ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr
, regno
);
4528 /* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by a reload
4529 needed for the part of the insn specified by OPNUM and TYPE,
4530 is still available in REGNO at the end of the insn.
4532 We can assume that the reload reg was already tested for availability
4533 at the time it is needed, and we should not check this again,
4534 in case the reg has already been marked in use. */
4537 reload_reg_reaches_end_p (regno
, opnum
, type
)
4540 enum reload_type type
;
4547 /* Since a RELOAD_OTHER reload claims the reg for the entire insn,
4548 its value must reach the end. */
4551 /* If this use is for part of the insn,
4552 its value reaches if no subsequent part uses the same register.
4553 Just like the above function, don't try to do this with lots
4556 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
:
4557 /* Here we check for everything else, since these don't conflict
4558 with anything else and everything comes later. */
4560 for (i
= 0; i
< reload_n_operands
; i
++)
4561 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr
[i
], regno
)
4562 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr
[i
], regno
)
4563 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output
[i
], regno
)
4564 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr
[i
], regno
)
4565 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr
[i
], regno
)
4566 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input
[i
], regno
))
4569 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr
, regno
)
4570 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn
, regno
)
4571 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used
, regno
));
4573 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
:
4574 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
:
4575 /* Similar, except that we check only for this and subsequent inputs
4576 and the address of only subsequent inputs and we do not need
4577 to check for RELOAD_OTHER objects since they are known not to
4580 for (i
= opnum
; i
< reload_n_operands
; i
++)
4581 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input
[i
], regno
))
4584 for (i
= opnum
+ 1; i
< reload_n_operands
; i
++)
4585 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr
[i
], regno
)
4586 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr
[i
], regno
))
4589 for (i
= 0; i
< reload_n_operands
; i
++)
4590 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr
[i
], regno
)
4591 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr
[i
], regno
)
4592 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output
[i
], regno
))
4595 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload
, regno
))
4598 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr
, regno
)
4599 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn
, regno
)
4600 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used
, regno
));
4602 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
:
4603 /* Similar to input address, except we start at the next operand for
4604 both input and input address and we do not check for
4605 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_INSN since these
4608 for (i
= opnum
+ 1; i
< reload_n_operands
; i
++)
4609 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr
[i
], regno
)
4610 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr
[i
], regno
)
4611 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input
[i
], regno
))
4614 /* ... fall through ... */
4616 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
:
4617 /* Check outputs and their addresses. */
4619 for (i
= 0; i
< reload_n_operands
; i
++)
4620 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr
[i
], regno
)
4621 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr
[i
], regno
)
4622 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output
[i
], regno
))
4625 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used
, regno
));
4627 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
:
4628 for (i
= 0; i
< reload_n_operands
; i
++)
4629 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr
[i
], regno
)
4630 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr
[i
], regno
)
4631 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output
[i
], regno
))
4634 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr
, regno
)
4635 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn
, regno
)
4636 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used
, regno
));
4638 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN
:
4639 /* These conflict with other outputs with RELOAD_OTHER. So
4640 we need only check for output addresses. */
4642 opnum
= reload_n_operands
;
4644 /* ... fall through ... */
4646 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
:
4647 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
:
4648 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS
:
4649 /* We already know these can't conflict with a later output. So the
4650 only thing to check are later output addresses.
4651 Note that multiple output operands are emitted in reverse order,
4652 so the conflicting ones are those with lower indices. */
4653 for (i
= 0; i
< opnum
; i
++)
4654 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr
[i
], regno
)
4655 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr
[i
], regno
))
4664 /* Return 1 if the reloads denoted by R1 and R2 cannot share a register.
4667 This function uses the same algorithm as reload_reg_free_p above. */
4670 reloads_conflict (r1
, r2
)
4673 enum reload_type r1_type
= rld
[r1
].when_needed
;
4674 enum reload_type r2_type
= rld
[r2
].when_needed
;
4675 int r1_opnum
= rld
[r1
].opnum
;
4676 int r2_opnum
= rld
[r2
].opnum
;
4678 /* RELOAD_OTHER conflicts with everything. */
4679 if (r2_type
== RELOAD_OTHER
)
4682 /* Otherwise, check conflicts differently for each type. */
4686 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
:
4687 return (r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_INSN
4688 || r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
4689 || r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
4690 || r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
4691 || ((r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
4692 || r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
)
4693 && r2_opnum
> r1_opnum
));
4695 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
:
4696 return ((r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
&& r1_opnum
== r2_opnum
)
4697 || (r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
&& r2_opnum
< r1_opnum
));
4699 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
:
4700 return ((r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
&& r1_opnum
== r2_opnum
)
4701 || (r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
&& r2_opnum
< r1_opnum
));
4703 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
:
4704 return ((r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
&& r2_opnum
== r1_opnum
)
4705 || (r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
&& r2_opnum
<= r1_opnum
));
4707 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS
:
4708 return ((r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS
&& r2_opnum
== r1_opnum
)
4709 || (r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
&& r2_opnum
<= r1_opnum
));
4711 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
:
4712 return (r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
|| r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_INSN
4713 || r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
);
4715 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
:
4716 return (r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
4717 || r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
);
4719 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
:
4720 return (r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_INSN
|| r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
4721 || ((r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
4722 || r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS
)
4723 && r2_opnum
>= r1_opnum
));
4725 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN
:
4726 return (r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
|| r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
4727 || r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_INSN
4728 || r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
);
4730 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
:
4731 return r2_type
== RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
;
4741 /* Indexed by reload number, 1 if incoming value
4742 inherited from previous insns. */
4743 char reload_inherited
[MAX_RELOADS
];
4745 /* For an inherited reload, this is the insn the reload was inherited from,
4746 if we know it. Otherwise, this is 0. */
4747 rtx reload_inheritance_insn
[MAX_RELOADS
];
4749 /* If non-zero, this is a place to get the value of the reload,
4750 rather than using reload_in. */
4751 rtx reload_override_in
[MAX_RELOADS
];
4753 /* For each reload, the hard register number of the register used,
4754 or -1 if we did not need a register for this reload. */
4755 int reload_spill_index
[MAX_RELOADS
];
4757 /* Subroutine of free_for_value_p, used to check a single register.
4758 START_REGNO is the starting regno of the full reload register
4759 (possibly comprising multiple hard registers) that we are considering. */
4762 reload_reg_free_for_value_p (start_regno
, regno
, opnum
, type
, value
, out
,
4763 reloadnum
, ignore_address_reloads
)
4764 int start_regno
, regno
;
4766 enum reload_type type
;
4769 int ignore_address_reloads
;
4772 /* Set if we see an input reload that must not share its reload register
4773 with any new earlyclobber, but might otherwise share the reload
4774 register with an output or input-output reload. */
4775 int check_earlyclobber
= 0;
4779 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable
, regno
))
4782 if (out
== const0_rtx
)
4788 /* We use some pseudo 'time' value to check if the lifetimes of the
4789 new register use would overlap with the one of a previous reload
4790 that is not read-only or uses a different value.
4791 The 'time' used doesn't have to be linear in any shape or form, just
4793 Some reload types use different 'buckets' for each operand.
4794 So there are MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS different time values for each
4796 We compute TIME1 as the time when the register for the prospective
4797 new reload ceases to be live, and TIME2 for each existing
4798 reload as the time when that the reload register of that reload
4800 Where there is little to be gained by exact lifetime calculations,
4801 we just make conservative assumptions, i.e. a longer lifetime;
4802 this is done in the 'default:' cases. */
4805 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
:
4806 /* RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS conflicts with RELOAD_OTHER reloads. */
4807 time1
= copy
? 0 : 1;
4810 time1
= copy
? 1 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 5 + 5;
4812 /* For each input, we may have a sequence of RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS,
4813 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_INPUT. By adding 0 / 1 / 2 ,
4814 respectively, to the time values for these, we get distinct time
4815 values. To get distinct time values for each operand, we have to
4816 multiply opnum by at least three. We round that up to four because
4817 multiply by four is often cheaper. */
4818 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
:
4819 time1
= opnum
* 4 + 2;
4821 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
:
4822 time1
= opnum
* 4 + 3;
4824 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
:
4825 /* All RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reloads remain live till the instruction
4826 executes (inclusive). */
4827 time1
= copy
? opnum
* 4 + 4 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 4 + 3;
4829 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
:
4831 <= (MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS - 1) * 4 + 4 == MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 */
4832 time1
= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 4 + 1;
4834 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
:
4835 /* RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads are live even while the insn
4837 time1
= copy
? MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 4 + 2 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 4 + 3;
4839 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS
:
4840 time1
= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 4 + 4 + opnum
;
4842 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
:
4843 time1
= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 4 + 5 + opnum
;
4846 time1
= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 5 + 5;
4849 for (i
= 0; i
< n_reloads
; i
++)
4851 rtx reg
= rld
[i
].reg_rtx
;
4852 if (reg
&& GET_CODE (reg
) == REG
4853 && ((unsigned) regno
- true_regnum (reg
)
4854 <= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO (reg
), GET_MODE (reg
)) - (unsigned) 1)
4857 rtx other_input
= rld
[i
].in
;
4859 /* If the other reload loads the same input value, that
4860 will not cause a conflict only if it's loading it into
4861 the same register. */
4862 if (true_regnum (reg
) != start_regno
)
4863 other_input
= NULL_RTX
;
4864 if (! other_input
|| ! rtx_equal_p (other_input
, value
)
4865 || rld
[i
].out
|| out
)
4868 switch (rld
[i
].when_needed
)
4870 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
:
4873 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
:
4874 /* find_reloads makes sure that a
4875 RELOAD_FOR_{INP,OP,OUT}ADDR_ADDRESS reload is only used
4876 by at most one - the first -
4877 RELOAD_FOR_{INPUT,OPERAND,OUTPUT}_ADDRESS . If the
4878 address reload is inherited, the address address reload
4879 goes away, so we can ignore this conflict. */
4880 if (type
== RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
&& reloadnum
== i
+ 1
4881 && ignore_address_reloads
4882 /* Unless the RELOAD_FOR_INPUT is an auto_inc expression.
4883 Then the address address is still needed to store
4884 back the new address. */
4885 && ! rld
[reloadnum
].out
)
4887 /* Likewise, if a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT can inherit a value, its
4888 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS / RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
4890 if (type
== RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
&& opnum
== rld
[i
].opnum
4891 && ignore_address_reloads
4892 /* Unless we are reloading an auto_inc expression. */
4893 && ! rld
[reloadnum
].out
)
4895 time2
= rld
[i
].opnum
* 4 + 2;
4897 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
:
4898 if (type
== RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
&& opnum
== rld
[i
].opnum
4899 && ignore_address_reloads
4900 && ! rld
[reloadnum
].out
)
4902 time2
= rld
[i
].opnum
* 4 + 3;
4904 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
:
4905 time2
= rld
[i
].opnum
* 4 + 4;
4906 check_earlyclobber
= 1;
4908 /* rld[i].opnum * 4 + 4 <= (MAX_RECOG_OPERAND - 1) * 4 + 4
4909 == MAX_RECOG_OPERAND * 4 */
4910 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
:
4911 if (type
== RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
&& reloadnum
== i
+ 1
4912 && ignore_address_reloads
4913 && ! rld
[reloadnum
].out
)
4915 time2
= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 4 + 1;
4917 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
:
4918 time2
= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 4 + 2;
4919 check_earlyclobber
= 1;
4921 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN
:
4922 time2
= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 4 + 3;
4924 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
:
4925 /* All RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reloads become live just after the
4926 instruction is executed. */
4927 time2
= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 4 + 4;
4929 /* The first RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reload conflicts with
4930 the RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reloads, so assign it the same time
4932 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS
:
4933 if (type
== RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
&& reloadnum
== i
+ 1
4934 && ignore_address_reloads
4935 && ! rld
[reloadnum
].out
)
4937 time2
= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 4 + 4 + rld
[i
].opnum
;
4939 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
:
4940 time2
= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 4 + 5 + rld
[i
].opnum
;
4943 /* If there is no conflict in the input part, handle this
4944 like an output reload. */
4945 if (! rld
[i
].in
|| rtx_equal_p (other_input
, value
))
4947 time2
= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 4 + 4;
4948 /* Earlyclobbered outputs must conflict with inputs. */
4949 if (earlyclobber_operand_p (rld
[i
].out
))
4950 time2
= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 4 + 3;
4955 /* RELOAD_OTHER might be live beyond instruction execution,
4956 but this is not obvious when we set time2 = 1. So check
4957 here if there might be a problem with the new reload
4958 clobbering the register used by the RELOAD_OTHER. */
4966 && (! rld
[i
].in
|| rld
[i
].out
4967 || ! rtx_equal_p (other_input
, value
)))
4968 || (out
&& rld
[reloadnum
].out_reg
4969 && time2
>= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
* 4 + 3))
4975 /* Earlyclobbered outputs must conflict with inputs. */
4976 if (check_earlyclobber
&& out
&& earlyclobber_operand_p (out
))
4982 /* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by a reload
4983 needed for the part of the insn specified by OPNUM and TYPE,
4984 may be used to load VALUE into it.
4986 MODE is the mode in which the register is used, this is needed to
4987 determine how many hard regs to test.
4989 Other read-only reloads with the same value do not conflict
4990 unless OUT is non-zero and these other reloads have to live while
4991 output reloads live.
4992 If OUT is CONST0_RTX, this is a special case: it means that the
4993 test should not be for using register REGNO as reload register, but
4994 for copying from register REGNO into the reload register.
4996 RELOADNUM is the number of the reload we want to load this value for;
4997 a reload does not conflict with itself.
4999 When IGNORE_ADDRESS_RELOADS is set, we can not have conflicts with
5000 reloads that load an address for the very reload we are considering.
5002 The caller has to make sure that there is no conflict with the return
5006 free_for_value_p (regno
, mode
, opnum
, type
, value
, out
, reloadnum
,
5007 ignore_address_reloads
)
5009 enum machine_mode mode
;
5011 enum reload_type type
;
5014 int ignore_address_reloads
;
5016 int nregs
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno
, mode
);
5018 if (! reload_reg_free_for_value_p (regno
, regno
+ nregs
, opnum
, type
,
5019 value
, out
, reloadnum
,
5020 ignore_address_reloads
))
5025 /* Determine whether the reload reg X overlaps any rtx'es used for
5026 overriding inheritance. Return nonzero if so. */
5029 conflicts_with_override (x
)
5033 for (i
= 0; i
< n_reloads
; i
++)
5034 if (reload_override_in
[i
]
5035 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x
, reload_override_in
[i
]))
5040 /* Give an error message saying we failed to find a reload for INSN,
5041 and clear out reload R. */
5043 failed_reload (insn
, r
)
5047 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn
)) < 0)
5048 /* It's the compiler's fault. */
5049 fatal_insn ("could not find a spill register", insn
);
5051 /* It's the user's fault; the operand's mode and constraint
5052 don't match. Disable this reload so we don't crash in final. */
5053 error_for_asm (insn
,
5054 "`asm' operand constraint incompatible with operand size");
5058 rld
[r
].optional
= 1;
5059 rld
[r
].secondary_p
= 1;
5062 /* I is the index in SPILL_REG_RTX of the reload register we are to allocate
5063 for reload R. If it's valid, get an rtx for it. Return nonzero if
5066 set_reload_reg (i
, r
)
5070 rtx reg
= spill_reg_rtx
[i
];
5072 if (reg
== 0 || GET_MODE (reg
) != rld
[r
].mode
)
5073 spill_reg_rtx
[i
] = reg
5074 = gen_rtx_REG (rld
[r
].mode
, spill_regs
[i
]);
5076 regno
= true_regnum (reg
);
5078 /* Detect when the reload reg can't hold the reload mode.
5079 This used to be one `if', but Sequent compiler can't handle that. */
5080 if (HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno
, rld
[r
].mode
))
5082 enum machine_mode test_mode
= VOIDmode
;
5084 test_mode
= GET_MODE (rld
[r
].in
);
5085 /* If rld[r].in has VOIDmode, it means we will load it
5086 in whatever mode the reload reg has: to wit, rld[r].mode.
5087 We have already tested that for validity. */
5088 /* Aside from that, we need to test that the expressions
5089 to reload from or into have modes which are valid for this
5090 reload register. Otherwise the reload insns would be invalid. */
5091 if (! (rld
[r
].in
!= 0 && test_mode
!= VOIDmode
5092 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno
, test_mode
)))
5093 if (! (rld
[r
].out
!= 0
5094 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno
, GET_MODE (rld
[r
].out
))))
5096 /* The reg is OK. */
5099 /* Mark as in use for this insn the reload regs we use
5101 mark_reload_reg_in_use (spill_regs
[i
], rld
[r
].opnum
,
5102 rld
[r
].when_needed
, rld
[r
].mode
);
5104 rld
[r
].reg_rtx
= reg
;
5105 reload_spill_index
[r
] = spill_regs
[i
];
5112 /* Find a spill register to use as a reload register for reload R.
5113 LAST_RELOAD is non-zero if this is the last reload for the insn being
5116 Set rld[R].reg_rtx to the register allocated.
5118 We return 1 if successful, or 0 if we couldn't find a spill reg and
5119 we didn't change anything. */
5122 allocate_reload_reg (chain
, r
, last_reload
)
5123 struct insn_chain
*chain ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
;
5129 /* If we put this reload ahead, thinking it is a group,
5130 then insist on finding a group. Otherwise we can grab a
5131 reg that some other reload needs.
5132 (That can happen when we have a 68000 DATA_OR_FP_REG
5133 which is a group of data regs or one fp reg.)
5134 We need not be so restrictive if there are no more reloads
5137 ??? Really it would be nicer to have smarter handling
5138 for that kind of reg class, where a problem like this is normal.
5139 Perhaps those classes should be avoided for reloading
5140 by use of more alternatives. */
5142 int force_group
= rld
[r
].nregs
> 1 && ! last_reload
;
5144 /* If we want a single register and haven't yet found one,
5145 take any reg in the right class and not in use.
5146 If we want a consecutive group, here is where we look for it.
5148 We use two passes so we can first look for reload regs to
5149 reuse, which are already in use for other reloads in this insn,
5150 and only then use additional registers.
5151 I think that maximizing reuse is needed to make sure we don't
5152 run out of reload regs. Suppose we have three reloads, and
5153 reloads A and B can share regs. These need two regs.
5154 Suppose A and B are given different regs.
5155 That leaves none for C. */
5156 for (pass
= 0; pass
< 2; pass
++)
5158 /* I is the index in spill_regs.
5159 We advance it round-robin between insns to use all spill regs
5160 equally, so that inherited reloads have a chance
5161 of leapfrogging each other. */
5165 for (count
= 0; count
< n_spills
; count
++)
5167 int class = (int) rld
[r
].class;
5173 regnum
= spill_regs
[i
];
5175 if ((reload_reg_free_p (regnum
, rld
[r
].opnum
,
5178 /* We check reload_reg_used to make sure we
5179 don't clobber the return register. */
5180 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used
, regnum
)
5181 && free_for_value_p (regnum
, rld
[r
].mode
, rld
[r
].opnum
,
5182 rld
[r
].when_needed
, rld
[r
].in
,
5184 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents
[class], regnum
)
5185 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regnum
, rld
[r
].mode
)
5186 /* Look first for regs to share, then for unshared. But
5187 don't share regs used for inherited reloads; they are
5188 the ones we want to preserve. */
5190 || (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all
,
5192 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit
,
5195 int nr
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regnum
, rld
[r
].mode
);
5196 /* Avoid the problem where spilling a GENERAL_OR_FP_REG
5197 (on 68000) got us two FP regs. If NR is 1,
5198 we would reject both of them. */
5201 /* If we need only one reg, we have already won. */
5204 /* But reject a single reg if we demand a group. */
5209 /* Otherwise check that as many consecutive regs as we need
5210 are available here. */
5213 int regno
= regnum
+ nr
- 1;
5214 if (!(TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents
[class], regno
)
5215 && spill_reg_order
[regno
] >= 0
5216 && reload_reg_free_p (regno
, rld
[r
].opnum
,
5217 rld
[r
].when_needed
)))
5226 /* If we found something on pass 1, omit pass 2. */
5227 if (count
< n_spills
)
5231 /* We should have found a spill register by now. */
5232 if (count
>= n_spills
)
5235 /* I is the index in SPILL_REG_RTX of the reload register we are to
5236 allocate. Get an rtx for it and find its register number. */
5238 return set_reload_reg (i
, r
);
5241 /* Initialize all the tables needed to allocate reload registers.
5242 CHAIN is the insn currently being processed; SAVE_RELOAD_REG_RTX
5243 is the array we use to restore the reg_rtx field for every reload. */
5246 choose_reload_regs_init (chain
, save_reload_reg_rtx
)
5247 struct insn_chain
*chain
;
5248 rtx
*save_reload_reg_rtx
;
5252 for (i
= 0; i
< n_reloads
; i
++)
5253 rld
[i
].reg_rtx
= save_reload_reg_rtx
[i
];
5255 memset (reload_inherited
, 0, MAX_RELOADS
);
5256 memset ((char *) reload_inheritance_insn
, 0, MAX_RELOADS
* sizeof (rtx
));
5257 memset ((char *) reload_override_in
, 0, MAX_RELOADS
* sizeof (rtx
));
5259 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used
);
5260 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_at_all
);
5261 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr
);
5262 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload
);
5263 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_insn
);
5264 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr
);
5266 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn
);
5269 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (tmp
, &chain
->live_throughout
);
5270 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn
, tmp
);
5271 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (tmp
, &chain
->dead_or_set
);
5272 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn
, tmp
);
5273 compute_use_by_pseudos (®_used_in_insn
, &chain
->live_throughout
);
5274 compute_use_by_pseudos (®_used_in_insn
, &chain
->dead_or_set
);
5277 for (i
= 0; i
< reload_n_operands
; i
++)
5279 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output
[i
]);
5280 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input
[i
]);
5281 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr
[i
]);
5282 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr
[i
]);
5283 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr
[i
]);
5284 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr
[i
]);
5287 COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_unavailable
, chain
->used_spill_regs
);
5289 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_for_inherit
);
5291 for (i
= 0; i
< n_reloads
; i
++)
5292 /* If we have already decided to use a certain register,
5293 don't use it in another way. */
5295 mark_reload_reg_in_use (REGNO (rld
[i
].reg_rtx
), rld
[i
].opnum
,
5296 rld
[i
].when_needed
, rld
[i
].mode
);
5299 /* Assign hard reg targets for the pseudo-registers we must reload
5300 into hard regs for this insn.
5301 Also output the instructions to copy them in and out of the hard regs.
5303 For machines with register classes, we are responsible for
5304 finding a reload reg in the proper class. */
5307 choose_reload_regs (chain
)
5308 struct insn_chain
*chain
;
5310 rtx insn
= chain
->insn
;
5312 unsigned int max_group_size
= 1;
5313 enum reg_class group_class
= NO_REGS
;
5314 int pass
, win
, inheritance
;
5316 rtx save_reload_reg_rtx
[MAX_RELOADS
];
5318 /* In order to be certain of getting the registers we need,
5319 we must sort the reloads into order of increasing register class.
5320 Then our grabbing of reload registers will parallel the process
5321 that provided the reload registers.
5323 Also note whether any of the reloads wants a consecutive group of regs.
5324 If so, record the maximum size of the group desired and what
5325 register class contains all the groups needed by this insn. */
5327 for (j
= 0; j
< n_reloads
; j
++)
5329 reload_order
[j
] = j
;
5330 reload_spill_index
[j
] = -1;
5332 if (rld
[j
].nregs
> 1)
5334 max_group_size
= MAX (rld
[j
].nregs
, max_group_size
);
5336 = reg_class_superunion
[(int) rld
[j
].class][(int) group_class
];
5339 save_reload_reg_rtx
[j
] = rld
[j
].reg_rtx
;
5343 qsort (reload_order
, n_reloads
, sizeof (short), reload_reg_class_lower
);
5345 /* If -O, try first with inheritance, then turning it off.
5346 If not -O, don't do inheritance.
5347 Using inheritance when not optimizing leads to paradoxes
5348 with fp on the 68k: fp numbers (not NaNs) fail to be equal to themselves
5349 because one side of the comparison might be inherited. */
5351 for (inheritance
= optimize
> 0; inheritance
>= 0; inheritance
--)
5353 choose_reload_regs_init (chain
, save_reload_reg_rtx
);
5355 /* Process the reloads in order of preference just found.
5356 Beyond this point, subregs can be found in reload_reg_rtx.
5358 This used to look for an existing reloaded home for all of the
5359 reloads, and only then perform any new reloads. But that could lose
5360 if the reloads were done out of reg-class order because a later
5361 reload with a looser constraint might have an old home in a register
5362 needed by an earlier reload with a tighter constraint.
5364 To solve this, we make two passes over the reloads, in the order
5365 described above. In the first pass we try to inherit a reload
5366 from a previous insn. If there is a later reload that needs a
5367 class that is a proper subset of the class being processed, we must
5368 also allocate a spill register during the first pass.
5370 Then make a second pass over the reloads to allocate any reloads
5371 that haven't been given registers yet. */
5373 for (j
= 0; j
< n_reloads
; j
++)
5375 int r
= reload_order
[j
];
5376 rtx search_equiv
= NULL_RTX
;
5378 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
5379 if (rld
[r
].out
== 0 && rld
[r
].in
== 0
5380 && ! rld
[r
].secondary_p
)
5383 /* If find_reloads chose to use reload_in or reload_out as a reload
5384 register, we don't need to chose one. Otherwise, try even if it
5385 found one since we might save an insn if we find the value lying
5387 Try also when reload_in is a pseudo without a hard reg. */
5388 if (rld
[r
].in
!= 0 && rld
[r
].reg_rtx
!= 0
5389 && (rtx_equal_p (rld
[r
].in
, rld
[r
].reg_rtx
)
5390 || (rtx_equal_p (rld
[r
].out
, rld
[r
].reg_rtx
)
5391 && GET_CODE (rld
[r
].in
) != MEM
5392 && true_regnum (rld
[r
].in
) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)))
5395 #if 0 /* No longer needed for correct operation.
5396 It might give better code, or might not; worth an experiment? */
5397 /* If this is an optional reload, we can't inherit from earlier insns
5398 until we are sure that any non-optional reloads have been allocated.
5399 The following code takes advantage of the fact that optional reloads
5400 are at the end of reload_order. */
5401 if (rld
[r
].optional
!= 0)
5402 for (i
= 0; i
< j
; i
++)
5403 if ((rld
[reload_order
[i
]].out
!= 0
5404 || rld
[reload_order
[i
]].in
!= 0
5405 || rld
[reload_order
[i
]].secondary_p
)
5406 && ! rld
[reload_order
[i
]].optional
5407 && rld
[reload_order
[i
]].reg_rtx
== 0)
5408 allocate_reload_reg (chain
, reload_order
[i
], 0);
5411 /* First see if this pseudo is already available as reloaded
5412 for a previous insn. We cannot try to inherit for reloads
5413 that are smaller than the maximum number of registers needed
5414 for groups unless the register we would allocate cannot be used
5417 We could check here to see if this is a secondary reload for
5418 an object that is already in a register of the desired class.
5419 This would avoid the need for the secondary reload register.
5420 But this is complex because we can't easily determine what
5421 objects might want to be loaded via this reload. So let a
5422 register be allocated here. In `emit_reload_insns' we suppress
5423 one of the loads in the case described above. */
5429 enum machine_mode mode
= VOIDmode
;
5433 else if (GET_CODE (rld
[r
].in
) == REG
)
5435 regno
= REGNO (rld
[r
].in
);
5436 mode
= GET_MODE (rld
[r
].in
);
5438 else if (GET_CODE (rld
[r
].in_reg
) == REG
)
5440 regno
= REGNO (rld
[r
].in_reg
);
5441 mode
= GET_MODE (rld
[r
].in_reg
);
5443 else if (GET_CODE (rld
[r
].in_reg
) == SUBREG
5444 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (rld
[r
].in_reg
)) == REG
)
5446 byte
= SUBREG_BYTE (rld
[r
].in_reg
);
5447 regno
= REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rld
[r
].in_reg
));
5448 if (regno
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
5449 regno
= subreg_regno (rld
[r
].in_reg
);
5450 mode
= GET_MODE (rld
[r
].in_reg
);
5453 else if ((GET_CODE (rld
[r
].in_reg
) == PRE_INC
5454 || GET_CODE (rld
[r
].in_reg
) == PRE_DEC
5455 || GET_CODE (rld
[r
].in_reg
) == POST_INC
5456 || GET_CODE (rld
[r
].in_reg
) == POST_DEC
)
5457 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rld
[r
].in_reg
, 0)) == REG
)
5459 regno
= REGNO (XEXP (rld
[r
].in_reg
, 0));
5460 mode
= GET_MODE (XEXP (rld
[r
].in_reg
, 0));
5461 rld
[r
].out
= rld
[r
].in
;
5465 /* This won't work, since REGNO can be a pseudo reg number.
5466 Also, it takes much more hair to keep track of all the things
5467 that can invalidate an inherited reload of part of a pseudoreg. */
5468 else if (GET_CODE (rld
[r
].in
) == SUBREG
5469 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (rld
[r
].in
)) == REG
)
5470 regno
= subreg_regno (rld
[r
].in
);
5473 if (regno
>= 0 && reg_last_reload_reg
[regno
] != 0)
5475 enum reg_class
class = rld
[r
].class, last_class
;
5476 rtx last_reg
= reg_last_reload_reg
[regno
];
5477 enum machine_mode need_mode
;
5479 i
= REGNO (last_reg
);
5480 i
+= subreg_regno_offset (i
, GET_MODE (last_reg
), byte
, mode
);
5481 last_class
= REGNO_REG_CLASS (i
);
5487 = smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
) + byte
,
5488 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode
));
5491 #ifdef CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE
5493 (reg_class_contents
[(int) CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE
], i
)
5494 ? ! CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (GET_MODE (last_reg
),
5496 : (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (last_reg
))
5497 >= GET_MODE_SIZE (need_mode
)))
5499 (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (last_reg
))
5500 >= GET_MODE_SIZE (need_mode
))
5502 && reg_reloaded_contents
[i
] == regno
5503 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid
, i
)
5504 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (i
, rld
[r
].mode
)
5505 && (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents
[(int) class], i
)
5506 /* Even if we can't use this register as a reload
5507 register, we might use it for reload_override_in,
5508 if copying it to the desired class is cheap
5510 || ((REGISTER_MOVE_COST (mode
, last_class
, class)
5511 < MEMORY_MOVE_COST (mode
, class, 1))
5512 #ifdef SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
5513 && (SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (class, mode
,
5517 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
5518 && ! SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (last_class
, class,
5523 && (rld
[r
].nregs
== max_group_size
5524 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents
[(int) group_class
],
5526 && free_for_value_p (i
, rld
[r
].mode
, rld
[r
].opnum
,
5527 rld
[r
].when_needed
, rld
[r
].in
,
5530 /* If a group is needed, verify that all the subsequent
5531 registers still have their values intact. */
5532 int nr
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i
, rld
[r
].mode
);
5535 for (k
= 1; k
< nr
; k
++)
5536 if (reg_reloaded_contents
[i
+ k
] != regno
5537 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid
, i
+ k
))
5545 last_reg
= (GET_MODE (last_reg
) == mode
5546 ? last_reg
: gen_rtx_REG (mode
, i
));
5549 for (k
= 0; k
< nr
; k
++)
5550 bad_for_class
|= ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents
[(int) rld
[r
].class],
5553 /* We found a register that contains the
5554 value we need. If this register is the
5555 same as an `earlyclobber' operand of the
5556 current insn, just mark it as a place to
5557 reload from since we can't use it as the
5558 reload register itself. */
5560 for (i1
= 0; i1
< n_earlyclobbers
; i1
++)
5561 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p
5562 (reg_last_reload_reg
[regno
],
5563 reload_earlyclobbers
[i1
]))
5566 if (i1
!= n_earlyclobbers
5567 || ! (free_for_value_p (i
, rld
[r
].mode
,
5569 rld
[r
].when_needed
, rld
[r
].in
,
5571 /* Don't use it if we'd clobber a pseudo reg. */
5572 || (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_used_in_insn
, i
)
5574 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead
, i
))
5575 /* Don't clobber the frame pointer. */
5576 || (i
== HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
5577 && frame_pointer_needed
5579 /* Don't really use the inherited spill reg
5580 if we need it wider than we've got it. */
5581 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (rld
[r
].mode
)
5582 > GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
))
5585 /* If find_reloads chose reload_out as reload
5586 register, stay with it - that leaves the
5587 inherited register for subsequent reloads. */
5588 || (rld
[r
].out
&& rld
[r
].reg_rtx
5589 && rtx_equal_p (rld
[r
].out
, rld
[r
].reg_rtx
)))
5591 if (! rld
[r
].optional
)
5593 reload_override_in
[r
] = last_reg
;
5594 reload_inheritance_insn
[r
]
5595 = reg_reloaded_insn
[i
];
5601 /* We can use this as a reload reg. */
5602 /* Mark the register as in use for this part of
5604 mark_reload_reg_in_use (i
,
5608 rld
[r
].reg_rtx
= last_reg
;
5609 reload_inherited
[r
] = 1;
5610 reload_inheritance_insn
[r
]
5611 = reg_reloaded_insn
[i
];
5612 reload_spill_index
[r
] = i
;
5613 for (k
= 0; k
< nr
; k
++)
5614 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit
,
5622 /* Here's another way to see if the value is already lying around. */
5625 && ! reload_inherited
[r
]
5627 && (CONSTANT_P (rld
[r
].in
)
5628 || GET_CODE (rld
[r
].in
) == PLUS
5629 || GET_CODE (rld
[r
].in
) == REG
5630 || GET_CODE (rld
[r
].in
) == MEM
)
5631 && (rld
[r
].nregs
== max_group_size
5632 || ! reg_classes_intersect_p (rld
[r
].class, group_class
)))
5633 search_equiv
= rld
[r
].in
;
5634 /* If this is an output reload from a simple move insn, look
5635 if an equivalence for the input is available. */
5636 else if (inheritance
&& rld
[r
].in
== 0 && rld
[r
].out
!= 0)
5638 rtx set
= single_set (insn
);
5641 && rtx_equal_p (rld
[r
].out
, SET_DEST (set
))
5642 && CONSTANT_P (SET_SRC (set
)))
5643 search_equiv
= SET_SRC (set
);
5649 = find_equiv_reg (search_equiv
, insn
, rld
[r
].class,
5650 -1, NULL
, 0, rld
[r
].mode
);
5655 if (GET_CODE (equiv
) == REG
)
5656 regno
= REGNO (equiv
);
5657 else if (GET_CODE (equiv
) == SUBREG
)
5659 /* This must be a SUBREG of a hard register.
5660 Make a new REG since this might be used in an
5661 address and not all machines support SUBREGs
5663 regno
= subreg_regno (equiv
);
5664 equiv
= gen_rtx_REG (rld
[r
].mode
, regno
);
5670 /* If we found a spill reg, reject it unless it is free
5671 and of the desired class. */
5673 && ((TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all
, regno
)
5674 && ! free_for_value_p (regno
, rld
[r
].mode
,
5675 rld
[r
].opnum
, rld
[r
].when_needed
,
5676 rld
[r
].in
, rld
[r
].out
, r
, 1))
5677 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents
[(int) rld
[r
].class],
5681 if (equiv
!= 0 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno
, rld
[r
].mode
))
5684 /* We found a register that contains the value we need.
5685 If this register is the same as an `earlyclobber' operand
5686 of the current insn, just mark it as a place to reload from
5687 since we can't use it as the reload register itself. */
5690 for (i
= 0; i
< n_earlyclobbers
; i
++)
5691 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (equiv
,
5692 reload_earlyclobbers
[i
]))
5694 if (! rld
[r
].optional
)
5695 reload_override_in
[r
] = equiv
;
5700 /* If the equiv register we have found is explicitly clobbered
5701 in the current insn, it depends on the reload type if we
5702 can use it, use it for reload_override_in, or not at all.
5703 In particular, we then can't use EQUIV for a
5704 RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload. */
5708 if (regno_clobbered_p (regno
, insn
, rld
[r
].mode
, 0))
5709 switch (rld
[r
].when_needed
)
5711 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
:
5712 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
:
5713 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
:
5714 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
:
5717 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
:
5718 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
:
5719 if (! rld
[r
].optional
)
5720 reload_override_in
[r
] = equiv
;
5726 else if (regno_clobbered_p (regno
, insn
, rld
[r
].mode
, 1))
5727 switch (rld
[r
].when_needed
)
5729 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
:
5730 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
:
5731 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
:
5732 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
:
5733 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
:
5734 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
:
5737 if (! rld
[r
].optional
)
5738 reload_override_in
[r
] = equiv
;
5746 /* If we found an equivalent reg, say no code need be generated
5747 to load it, and use it as our reload reg. */
5749 && (regno
!= HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
5750 || !frame_pointer_needed
))
5752 int nr
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno
, rld
[r
].mode
);
5754 rld
[r
].reg_rtx
= equiv
;
5755 reload_inherited
[r
] = 1;
5757 /* If reg_reloaded_valid is not set for this register,
5758 there might be a stale spill_reg_store lying around.
5759 We must clear it, since otherwise emit_reload_insns
5760 might delete the store. */
5761 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid
, regno
))
5762 spill_reg_store
[regno
] = NULL_RTX
;
5763 /* If any of the hard registers in EQUIV are spill
5764 registers, mark them as in use for this insn. */
5765 for (k
= 0; k
< nr
; k
++)
5767 i
= spill_reg_order
[regno
+ k
];
5770 mark_reload_reg_in_use (regno
, rld
[r
].opnum
,
5773 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit
,
5780 /* If we found a register to use already, or if this is an optional
5781 reload, we are done. */
5782 if (rld
[r
].reg_rtx
!= 0 || rld
[r
].optional
!= 0)
5786 /* No longer needed for correct operation. Might or might
5787 not give better code on the average. Want to experiment? */
5789 /* See if there is a later reload that has a class different from our
5790 class that intersects our class or that requires less register
5791 than our reload. If so, we must allocate a register to this
5792 reload now, since that reload might inherit a previous reload
5793 and take the only available register in our class. Don't do this
5794 for optional reloads since they will force all previous reloads
5795 to be allocated. Also don't do this for reloads that have been
5798 for (i
= j
+ 1; i
< n_reloads
; i
++)
5800 int s
= reload_order
[i
];
5802 if ((rld
[s
].in
== 0 && rld
[s
].out
== 0
5803 && ! rld
[s
].secondary_p
)
5807 if ((rld
[s
].class != rld
[r
].class
5808 && reg_classes_intersect_p (rld
[r
].class,
5810 || rld
[s
].nregs
< rld
[r
].nregs
)
5817 allocate_reload_reg (chain
, r
, j
== n_reloads
- 1);
5821 /* Now allocate reload registers for anything non-optional that
5822 didn't get one yet. */
5823 for (j
= 0; j
< n_reloads
; j
++)
5825 int r
= reload_order
[j
];
5827 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
5828 if (rld
[r
].out
== 0 && rld
[r
].in
== 0 && ! rld
[r
].secondary_p
)
5831 /* Skip reloads that already have a register allocated or are
5833 if (rld
[r
].reg_rtx
!= 0 || rld
[r
].optional
)
5836 if (! allocate_reload_reg (chain
, r
, j
== n_reloads
- 1))
5840 /* If that loop got all the way, we have won. */
5847 /* Loop around and try without any inheritance. */
5852 /* First undo everything done by the failed attempt
5853 to allocate with inheritance. */
5854 choose_reload_regs_init (chain
, save_reload_reg_rtx
);
5856 /* Some sanity tests to verify that the reloads found in the first
5857 pass are identical to the ones we have now. */
5858 if (chain
->n_reloads
!= n_reloads
)
5861 for (i
= 0; i
< n_reloads
; i
++)
5863 if (chain
->rld
[i
].regno
< 0 || chain
->rld
[i
].reg_rtx
!= 0)
5865 if (chain
->rld
[i
].when_needed
!= rld
[i
].when_needed
)
5867 for (j
= 0; j
< n_spills
; j
++)
5868 if (spill_regs
[j
] == chain
->rld
[i
].regno
)
5869 if (! set_reload_reg (j
, i
))
5870 failed_reload (chain
->insn
, i
);
5874 /* If we thought we could inherit a reload, because it seemed that
5875 nothing else wanted the same reload register earlier in the insn,
5876 verify that assumption, now that all reloads have been assigned.
5877 Likewise for reloads where reload_override_in has been set. */
5879 /* If doing expensive optimizations, do one preliminary pass that doesn't
5880 cancel any inheritance, but removes reloads that have been needed only
5881 for reloads that we know can be inherited. */
5882 for (pass
= flag_expensive_optimizations
; pass
>= 0; pass
--)
5884 for (j
= 0; j
< n_reloads
; j
++)
5886 int r
= reload_order
[j
];
5888 if (reload_inherited
[r
] && rld
[r
].reg_rtx
)
5889 check_reg
= rld
[r
].reg_rtx
;
5890 else if (reload_override_in
[r
]
5891 && (GET_CODE (reload_override_in
[r
]) == REG
5892 || GET_CODE (reload_override_in
[r
]) == SUBREG
))
5893 check_reg
= reload_override_in
[r
];
5896 if (! free_for_value_p (true_regnum (check_reg
), rld
[r
].mode
,
5897 rld
[r
].opnum
, rld
[r
].when_needed
, rld
[r
].in
,
5898 (reload_inherited
[r
]
5899 ? rld
[r
].out
: const0_rtx
),
5904 reload_inherited
[r
] = 0;
5905 reload_override_in
[r
] = 0;
5907 /* If we can inherit a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT, or can use a
5908 reload_override_in, then we do not need its related
5909 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS / RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads;
5910 likewise for other reload types.
5911 We handle this by removing a reload when its only replacement
5912 is mentioned in reload_in of the reload we are going to inherit.
5913 A special case are auto_inc expressions; even if the input is
5914 inherited, we still need the address for the output. We can
5915 recognize them because they have RELOAD_OUT set to RELOAD_IN.
5916 If we succeeded removing some reload and we are doing a preliminary
5917 pass just to remove such reloads, make another pass, since the
5918 removal of one reload might allow us to inherit another one. */
5920 && rld
[r
].out
!= rld
[r
].in
5921 && remove_address_replacements (rld
[r
].in
) && pass
)
5926 /* Now that reload_override_in is known valid,
5927 actually override reload_in. */
5928 for (j
= 0; j
< n_reloads
; j
++)
5929 if (reload_override_in
[j
])
5930 rld
[j
].in
= reload_override_in
[j
];
5932 /* If this reload won't be done because it has been cancelled or is
5933 optional and not inherited, clear reload_reg_rtx so other
5934 routines (such as subst_reloads) don't get confused. */
5935 for (j
= 0; j
< n_reloads
; j
++)
5936 if (rld
[j
].reg_rtx
!= 0
5937 && ((rld
[j
].optional
&& ! reload_inherited
[j
])
5938 || (rld
[j
].in
== 0 && rld
[j
].out
== 0
5939 && ! rld
[j
].secondary_p
)))
5941 int regno
= true_regnum (rld
[j
].reg_rtx
);
5943 if (spill_reg_order
[regno
] >= 0)
5944 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno
, rld
[j
].opnum
,
5945 rld
[j
].when_needed
, rld
[j
].mode
);
5947 reload_spill_index
[j
] = -1;
5950 /* Record which pseudos and which spill regs have output reloads. */
5951 for (j
= 0; j
< n_reloads
; j
++)
5953 int r
= reload_order
[j
];
5955 i
= reload_spill_index
[r
];
5957 /* I is nonneg if this reload uses a register.
5958 If rld[r].reg_rtx is 0, this is an optional reload
5959 that we opted to ignore. */
5960 if (rld
[r
].out_reg
!= 0 && GET_CODE (rld
[r
].out_reg
) == REG
5961 && rld
[r
].reg_rtx
!= 0)
5963 int nregno
= REGNO (rld
[r
].out_reg
);
5966 if (nregno
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
5967 nr
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (nregno
, rld
[r
].mode
);
5970 reg_has_output_reload
[nregno
+ nr
] = 1;
5974 nr
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i
, rld
[r
].mode
);
5976 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload
, i
+ nr
);
5979 if (rld
[r
].when_needed
!= RELOAD_OTHER
5980 && rld
[r
].when_needed
!= RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
5981 && rld
[r
].when_needed
!= RELOAD_FOR_INSN
)
5987 /* Deallocate the reload register for reload R. This is called from
5988 remove_address_replacements. */
5991 deallocate_reload_reg (r
)
5996 if (! rld
[r
].reg_rtx
)
5998 regno
= true_regnum (rld
[r
].reg_rtx
);
6000 if (spill_reg_order
[regno
] >= 0)
6001 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno
, rld
[r
].opnum
, rld
[r
].when_needed
,
6003 reload_spill_index
[r
] = -1;
6006 /* If SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES is non-zero, we may not have merged two
6007 reloads of the same item for fear that we might not have enough reload
6008 registers. However, normally they will get the same reload register
6009 and hence actually need not be loaded twice.
6011 Here we check for the most common case of this phenomenon: when we have
6012 a number of reloads for the same object, each of which were allocated
6013 the same reload_reg_rtx, that reload_reg_rtx is not used for any other
6014 reload, and is not modified in the insn itself. If we find such,
6015 merge all the reloads and set the resulting reload to RELOAD_OTHER.
6016 This will not increase the number of spill registers needed and will
6017 prevent redundant code. */
6020 merge_assigned_reloads (insn
)
6025 /* Scan all the reloads looking for ones that only load values and
6026 are not already RELOAD_OTHER and ones whose reload_reg_rtx are
6027 assigned and not modified by INSN. */
6029 for (i
= 0; i
< n_reloads
; i
++)
6031 int conflicting_input
= 0;
6032 int max_input_address_opnum
= -1;
6033 int min_conflicting_input_opnum
= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
;
6035 if (rld
[i
].in
== 0 || rld
[i
].when_needed
== RELOAD_OTHER
6036 || rld
[i
].out
!= 0 || rld
[i
].reg_rtx
== 0
6037 || reg_set_p (rld
[i
].reg_rtx
, insn
))
6040 /* Look at all other reloads. Ensure that the only use of this
6041 reload_reg_rtx is in a reload that just loads the same value
6042 as we do. Note that any secondary reloads must be of the identical
6043 class since the values, modes, and result registers are the
6044 same, so we need not do anything with any secondary reloads. */
6046 for (j
= 0; j
< n_reloads
; j
++)
6048 if (i
== j
|| rld
[j
].reg_rtx
== 0
6049 || ! reg_overlap_mentioned_p (rld
[j
].reg_rtx
,
6053 if (rld
[j
].when_needed
== RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6054 && rld
[j
].opnum
> max_input_address_opnum
)
6055 max_input_address_opnum
= rld
[j
].opnum
;
6057 /* If the reload regs aren't exactly the same (e.g, different modes)
6058 or if the values are different, we can't merge this reload.
6059 But if it is an input reload, we might still merge
6060 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reloads. */
6062 if (! rtx_equal_p (rld
[i
].reg_rtx
, rld
[j
].reg_rtx
)
6063 || rld
[j
].out
!= 0 || rld
[j
].in
== 0
6064 || ! rtx_equal_p (rld
[i
].in
, rld
[j
].in
))
6066 if (rld
[j
].when_needed
!= RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
6067 || ((rld
[i
].when_needed
!= RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6068 || rld
[i
].opnum
> rld
[j
].opnum
)
6069 && rld
[i
].when_needed
!= RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
))
6071 conflicting_input
= 1;
6072 if (min_conflicting_input_opnum
> rld
[j
].opnum
)
6073 min_conflicting_input_opnum
= rld
[j
].opnum
;
6077 /* If all is OK, merge the reloads. Only set this to RELOAD_OTHER if
6078 we, in fact, found any matching reloads. */
6081 && max_input_address_opnum
<= min_conflicting_input_opnum
)
6083 for (j
= 0; j
< n_reloads
; j
++)
6084 if (i
!= j
&& rld
[j
].reg_rtx
!= 0
6085 && rtx_equal_p (rld
[i
].reg_rtx
, rld
[j
].reg_rtx
)
6086 && (! conflicting_input
6087 || rld
[j
].when_needed
== RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6088 || rld
[j
].when_needed
== RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
))
6090 rld
[i
].when_needed
= RELOAD_OTHER
;
6092 reload_spill_index
[j
] = -1;
6093 transfer_replacements (i
, j
);
6096 /* If this is now RELOAD_OTHER, look for any reloads that load
6097 parts of this operand and set them to RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
6098 if they were for inputs, RELOAD_OTHER for outputs. Note that
6099 this test is equivalent to looking for reloads for this operand
6102 if (rld
[i
].when_needed
== RELOAD_OTHER
)
6103 for (j
= 0; j
< n_reloads
; j
++)
6105 && rld
[j
].when_needed
!= RELOAD_OTHER
6106 && reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (rld
[j
].in
,
6109 = ((rld
[j
].when_needed
== RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6110 || rld
[j
].when_needed
== RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
)
6111 ? RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
: RELOAD_OTHER
);
6116 /* These arrays are filled by emit_reload_insns and its subroutines. */
6117 static rtx input_reload_insns
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
6118 static rtx other_input_address_reload_insns
= 0;
6119 static rtx other_input_reload_insns
= 0;
6120 static rtx input_address_reload_insns
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
6121 static rtx inpaddr_address_reload_insns
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
6122 static rtx output_reload_insns
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
6123 static rtx output_address_reload_insns
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
6124 static rtx outaddr_address_reload_insns
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
6125 static rtx operand_reload_insns
= 0;
6126 static rtx other_operand_reload_insns
= 0;
6127 static rtx other_output_reload_insns
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
6129 /* Values to be put in spill_reg_store are put here first. */
6130 static rtx new_spill_reg_store
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
6131 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_died
;
6133 /* Generate insns to perform reload RL, which is for the insn in CHAIN and
6134 has the number J. OLD contains the value to be used as input. */
6137 emit_input_reload_insns (chain
, rl
, old
, j
)
6138 struct insn_chain
*chain
;
6143 rtx insn
= chain
->insn
;
6144 rtx reloadreg
= rl
->reg_rtx
;
6145 rtx oldequiv_reg
= 0;
6148 enum machine_mode mode
;
6151 /* Determine the mode to reload in.
6152 This is very tricky because we have three to choose from.
6153 There is the mode the insn operand wants (rl->inmode).
6154 There is the mode of the reload register RELOADREG.
6155 There is the intrinsic mode of the operand, which we could find
6156 by stripping some SUBREGs.
6157 It turns out that RELOADREG's mode is irrelevant:
6158 we can change that arbitrarily.
6160 Consider (SUBREG:SI foo:QI) as an operand that must be SImode;
6161 then the reload reg may not support QImode moves, so use SImode.
6162 If foo is in memory due to spilling a pseudo reg, this is safe,
6163 because the QImode value is in the least significant part of a
6164 slot big enough for a SImode. If foo is some other sort of
6165 memory reference, then it is impossible to reload this case,
6166 so previous passes had better make sure this never happens.
6168 Then consider a one-word union which has SImode and one of its
6169 members is a float, being fetched as (SUBREG:SF union:SI).
6170 We must fetch that as SFmode because we could be loading into
6171 a float-only register. In this case OLD's mode is correct.
6173 Consider an immediate integer: it has VOIDmode. Here we need
6174 to get a mode from something else.
6176 In some cases, there is a fourth mode, the operand's
6177 containing mode. If the insn specifies a containing mode for
6178 this operand, it overrides all others.
6180 I am not sure whether the algorithm here is always right,
6181 but it does the right things in those cases. */
6183 mode
= GET_MODE (old
);
6184 if (mode
== VOIDmode
)
6187 #ifdef SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
6188 /* If we need a secondary register for this operation, see if
6189 the value is already in a register in that class. Don't
6190 do this if the secondary register will be used as a scratch
6193 if (rl
->secondary_in_reload
>= 0
6194 && rl
->secondary_in_icode
== CODE_FOR_nothing
6197 = find_equiv_reg (old
, insn
,
6198 rld
[rl
->secondary_in_reload
].class,
6202 /* If reloading from memory, see if there is a register
6203 that already holds the same value. If so, reload from there.
6204 We can pass 0 as the reload_reg_p argument because
6205 any other reload has either already been emitted,
6206 in which case find_equiv_reg will see the reload-insn,
6207 or has yet to be emitted, in which case it doesn't matter
6208 because we will use this equiv reg right away. */
6210 if (oldequiv
== 0 && optimize
6211 && (GET_CODE (old
) == MEM
6212 || (GET_CODE (old
) == REG
6213 && REGNO (old
) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6214 && reg_renumber
[REGNO (old
)] < 0)))
6215 oldequiv
= find_equiv_reg (old
, insn
, ALL_REGS
, -1, NULL
, 0, mode
);
6219 unsigned int regno
= true_regnum (oldequiv
);
6221 /* Don't use OLDEQUIV if any other reload changes it at an
6222 earlier stage of this insn or at this stage. */
6223 if (! free_for_value_p (regno
, rl
->mode
, rl
->opnum
, rl
->when_needed
,
6224 rl
->in
, const0_rtx
, j
, 0))
6227 /* If it is no cheaper to copy from OLDEQUIV into the
6228 reload register than it would be to move from memory,
6229 don't use it. Likewise, if we need a secondary register
6233 && ((REGNO_REG_CLASS (regno
) != rl
->class
6234 && (REGISTER_MOVE_COST (mode
, REGNO_REG_CLASS (regno
),
6236 >= MEMORY_MOVE_COST (mode
, rl
->class, 1)))
6237 #ifdef SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
6238 || (SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rl
->class,
6242 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
6243 || SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (REGNO_REG_CLASS (regno
),
6251 /* delete_output_reload is only invoked properly if old contains
6252 the original pseudo register. Since this is replaced with a
6253 hard reg when RELOAD_OVERRIDE_IN is set, see if we can
6254 find the pseudo in RELOAD_IN_REG. */
6256 && reload_override_in
[j
]
6257 && GET_CODE (rl
->in_reg
) == REG
)
6264 else if (GET_CODE (oldequiv
) == REG
)
6265 oldequiv_reg
= oldequiv
;
6266 else if (GET_CODE (oldequiv
) == SUBREG
)
6267 oldequiv_reg
= SUBREG_REG (oldequiv
);
6269 /* If we are reloading from a register that was recently stored in
6270 with an output-reload, see if we can prove there was
6271 actually no need to store the old value in it. */
6273 if (optimize
&& GET_CODE (oldequiv
) == REG
6274 && REGNO (oldequiv
) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6275 && spill_reg_store
[REGNO (oldequiv
)]
6276 && GET_CODE (old
) == REG
6277 && (dead_or_set_p (insn
, spill_reg_stored_to
[REGNO (oldequiv
)])
6278 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to
[REGNO (oldequiv
)],
6280 delete_output_reload (insn
, j
, REGNO (oldequiv
));
6282 /* Encapsulate both RELOADREG and OLDEQUIV into that mode,
6283 then load RELOADREG from OLDEQUIV. Note that we cannot use
6284 gen_lowpart_common since it can do the wrong thing when
6285 RELOADREG has a multi-word mode. Note that RELOADREG
6286 must always be a REG here. */
6288 if (GET_MODE (reloadreg
) != mode
)
6289 reloadreg
= gen_rtx_REG (mode
, REGNO (reloadreg
));
6290 while (GET_CODE (oldequiv
) == SUBREG
&& GET_MODE (oldequiv
) != mode
)
6291 oldequiv
= SUBREG_REG (oldequiv
);
6292 if (GET_MODE (oldequiv
) != VOIDmode
6293 && mode
!= GET_MODE (oldequiv
))
6294 oldequiv
= gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode
, oldequiv
);
6296 /* Switch to the right place to emit the reload insns. */
6297 switch (rl
->when_needed
)
6300 where
= &other_input_reload_insns
;
6302 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
:
6303 where
= &input_reload_insns
[rl
->opnum
];
6305 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
:
6306 where
= &input_address_reload_insns
[rl
->opnum
];
6308 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
:
6309 where
= &inpaddr_address_reload_insns
[rl
->opnum
];
6311 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
:
6312 where
= &output_address_reload_insns
[rl
->opnum
];
6314 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS
:
6315 where
= &outaddr_address_reload_insns
[rl
->opnum
];
6317 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
:
6318 where
= &operand_reload_insns
;
6320 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
:
6321 where
= &other_operand_reload_insns
;
6323 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
:
6324 where
= &other_input_address_reload_insns
;
6330 push_to_sequence (*where
);
6332 /* Auto-increment addresses must be reloaded in a special way. */
6333 if (rl
->out
&& ! rl
->out_reg
)
6335 /* We are not going to bother supporting the case where a
6336 incremented register can't be copied directly from
6337 OLDEQUIV since this seems highly unlikely. */
6338 if (rl
->secondary_in_reload
>= 0)
6341 if (reload_inherited
[j
])
6342 oldequiv
= reloadreg
;
6344 old
= XEXP (rl
->in_reg
, 0);
6346 if (optimize
&& GET_CODE (oldequiv
) == REG
6347 && REGNO (oldequiv
) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6348 && spill_reg_store
[REGNO (oldequiv
)]
6349 && GET_CODE (old
) == REG
6350 && (dead_or_set_p (insn
,
6351 spill_reg_stored_to
[REGNO (oldequiv
)])
6352 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to
[REGNO (oldequiv
)],
6354 delete_output_reload (insn
, j
, REGNO (oldequiv
));
6356 /* Prevent normal processing of this reload. */
6358 /* Output a special code sequence for this case. */
6359 new_spill_reg_store
[REGNO (reloadreg
)]
6360 = inc_for_reload (reloadreg
, oldequiv
, rl
->out
,
6364 /* If we are reloading a pseudo-register that was set by the previous
6365 insn, see if we can get rid of that pseudo-register entirely
6366 by redirecting the previous insn into our reload register. */
6368 else if (optimize
&& GET_CODE (old
) == REG
6369 && REGNO (old
) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6370 && dead_or_set_p (insn
, old
)
6371 /* This is unsafe if some other reload
6372 uses the same reg first. */
6373 && ! conflicts_with_override (reloadreg
)
6374 && free_for_value_p (REGNO (reloadreg
), rl
->mode
, rl
->opnum
,
6375 rl
->when_needed
, old
, rl
->out
, j
, 0))
6377 rtx temp
= PREV_INSN (insn
);
6378 while (temp
&& GET_CODE (temp
) == NOTE
)
6379 temp
= PREV_INSN (temp
);
6381 && GET_CODE (temp
) == INSN
6382 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (temp
)) == SET
6383 && SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp
)) == old
6384 /* Make sure we can access insn_operand_constraint. */
6385 && asm_noperands (PATTERN (temp
)) < 0
6386 /* This is unsafe if prev insn rejects our reload reg. */
6387 && constraint_accepts_reg_p (insn_data
[recog_memoized (temp
)].operand
[0].constraint
,
6389 /* This is unsafe if operand occurs more than once in current
6390 insn. Perhaps some occurrences aren't reloaded. */
6391 && count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn
), old
, 0) == 1
6392 /* Don't risk splitting a matching pair of operands. */
6393 && ! reg_mentioned_p (old
, SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp
))))
6395 /* Store into the reload register instead of the pseudo. */
6396 SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp
)) = reloadreg
;
6398 /* If the previous insn is an output reload, the source is
6399 a reload register, and its spill_reg_store entry will
6400 contain the previous destination. This is now
6402 if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp
))) == REG
6403 && REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp
))) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
6405 spill_reg_store
[REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp
)))] = 0;
6406 spill_reg_stored_to
[REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp
)))] = 0;
6409 /* If these are the only uses of the pseudo reg,
6410 pretend for GDB it lives in the reload reg we used. */
6411 if (REG_N_DEATHS (REGNO (old
)) == 1
6412 && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (old
)) == 1)
6414 reg_renumber
[REGNO (old
)] = REGNO (rl
->reg_rtx
);
6415 alter_reg (REGNO (old
), -1);
6421 /* We can't do that, so output an insn to load RELOADREG. */
6423 #ifdef SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
6424 /* If we have a secondary reload, pick up the secondary register
6425 and icode, if any. If OLDEQUIV and OLD are different or
6426 if this is an in-out reload, recompute whether or not we
6427 still need a secondary register and what the icode should
6428 be. If we still need a secondary register and the class or
6429 icode is different, go back to reloading from OLD if using
6430 OLDEQUIV means that we got the wrong type of register. We
6431 cannot have different class or icode due to an in-out reload
6432 because we don't make such reloads when both the input and
6433 output need secondary reload registers. */
6435 if (! special
&& rl
->secondary_in_reload
>= 0)
6437 rtx second_reload_reg
= 0;
6438 int secondary_reload
= rl
->secondary_in_reload
;
6439 rtx real_oldequiv
= oldequiv
;
6442 enum insn_code icode
;
6444 /* If OLDEQUIV is a pseudo with a MEM, get the real MEM
6445 and similarly for OLD.
6446 See comments in get_secondary_reload in reload.c. */
6447 /* If it is a pseudo that cannot be replaced with its
6448 equivalent MEM, we must fall back to reload_in, which
6449 will have all the necessary substitutions registered.
6450 Likewise for a pseudo that can't be replaced with its
6451 equivalent constant.
6453 Take extra care for subregs of such pseudos. Note that
6454 we cannot use reg_equiv_mem in this case because it is
6455 not in the right mode. */
6458 if (GET_CODE (tmp
) == SUBREG
)
6459 tmp
= SUBREG_REG (tmp
);
6460 if (GET_CODE (tmp
) == REG
6461 && REGNO (tmp
) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6462 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc
[REGNO (tmp
)] != 0
6463 || reg_equiv_constant
[REGNO (tmp
)] != 0))
6465 if (! reg_equiv_mem
[REGNO (tmp
)]
6466 || num_not_at_initial_offset
6467 || GET_CODE (oldequiv
) == SUBREG
)
6468 real_oldequiv
= rl
->in
;
6470 real_oldequiv
= reg_equiv_mem
[REGNO (tmp
)];
6474 if (GET_CODE (tmp
) == SUBREG
)
6475 tmp
= SUBREG_REG (tmp
);
6476 if (GET_CODE (tmp
) == REG
6477 && REGNO (tmp
) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6478 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc
[REGNO (tmp
)] != 0
6479 || reg_equiv_constant
[REGNO (tmp
)] != 0))
6481 if (! reg_equiv_mem
[REGNO (tmp
)]
6482 || num_not_at_initial_offset
6483 || GET_CODE (old
) == SUBREG
)
6486 real_old
= reg_equiv_mem
[REGNO (tmp
)];
6489 second_reload_reg
= rld
[secondary_reload
].reg_rtx
;
6490 icode
= rl
->secondary_in_icode
;
6492 if ((old
!= oldequiv
&& ! rtx_equal_p (old
, oldequiv
))
6493 || (rl
->in
!= 0 && rl
->out
!= 0))
6495 enum reg_class new_class
6496 = SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rl
->class,
6497 mode
, real_oldequiv
);
6499 if (new_class
== NO_REGS
)
6500 second_reload_reg
= 0;
6503 enum insn_code new_icode
;
6504 enum machine_mode new_mode
;
6506 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents
[(int) new_class
],
6507 REGNO (second_reload_reg
)))
6508 oldequiv
= old
, real_oldequiv
= real_old
;
6511 new_icode
= reload_in_optab
[(int) mode
];
6512 if (new_icode
!= CODE_FOR_nothing
6513 && ((insn_data
[(int) new_icode
].operand
[0].predicate
6514 && ! ((*insn_data
[(int) new_icode
].operand
[0].predicate
)
6516 || (insn_data
[(int) new_icode
].operand
[1].predicate
6517 && ! ((*insn_data
[(int) new_icode
].operand
[1].predicate
)
6518 (real_oldequiv
, mode
)))))
6519 new_icode
= CODE_FOR_nothing
;
6521 if (new_icode
== CODE_FOR_nothing
)
6524 new_mode
= insn_data
[(int) new_icode
].operand
[2].mode
;
6526 if (GET_MODE (second_reload_reg
) != new_mode
)
6528 if (!HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (second_reload_reg
),
6530 oldequiv
= old
, real_oldequiv
= real_old
;
6533 = gen_rtx_REG (new_mode
,
6534 REGNO (second_reload_reg
));
6540 /* If we still need a secondary reload register, check
6541 to see if it is being used as a scratch or intermediate
6542 register and generate code appropriately. If we need
6543 a scratch register, use REAL_OLDEQUIV since the form of
6544 the insn may depend on the actual address if it is
6547 if (second_reload_reg
)
6549 if (icode
!= CODE_FOR_nothing
)
6551 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode
) (reloadreg
, real_oldequiv
,
6552 second_reload_reg
));
6557 /* See if we need a scratch register to load the
6558 intermediate register (a tertiary reload). */
6559 enum insn_code tertiary_icode
6560 = rld
[secondary_reload
].secondary_in_icode
;
6562 if (tertiary_icode
!= CODE_FOR_nothing
)
6564 rtx third_reload_reg
6565 = rld
[rld
[secondary_reload
].secondary_in_reload
].reg_rtx
;
6567 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (tertiary_icode
)
6568 (second_reload_reg
, real_oldequiv
,
6569 third_reload_reg
)));
6572 gen_reload (second_reload_reg
, real_oldequiv
,
6576 oldequiv
= second_reload_reg
;
6582 if (! special
&& ! rtx_equal_p (reloadreg
, oldequiv
))
6584 rtx real_oldequiv
= oldequiv
;
6586 if ((GET_CODE (oldequiv
) == REG
6587 && REGNO (oldequiv
) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6588 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc
[REGNO (oldequiv
)] != 0
6589 || reg_equiv_constant
[REGNO (oldequiv
)] != 0))
6590 || (GET_CODE (oldequiv
) == SUBREG
6591 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv
)) == REG
6592 && (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv
))
6593 >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
6594 && ((reg_equiv_memory_loc
6595 [REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv
))] != 0)
6596 || (reg_equiv_constant
6597 [REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv
))] != 0)))
6598 || (CONSTANT_P (oldequiv
)
6599 && (PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (oldequiv
,
6600 REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (reloadreg
)))
6602 real_oldequiv
= rl
->in
;
6603 gen_reload (reloadreg
, real_oldequiv
, rl
->opnum
,
6607 if (flag_non_call_exceptions
)
6608 copy_eh_notes (insn
, get_insns ());
6610 /* End this sequence. */
6611 *where
= get_insns ();
6614 /* Update reload_override_in so that delete_address_reloads_1
6615 can see the actual register usage. */
6617 reload_override_in
[j
] = oldequiv
;
6620 /* Generate insns to for the output reload RL, which is for the insn described
6621 by CHAIN and has the number J. */
6623 emit_output_reload_insns (chain
, rl
, j
)
6624 struct insn_chain
*chain
;
6628 rtx reloadreg
= rl
->reg_rtx
;
6629 rtx insn
= chain
->insn
;
6632 enum machine_mode mode
= GET_MODE (old
);
6635 if (rl
->when_needed
== RELOAD_OTHER
)
6638 push_to_sequence (output_reload_insns
[rl
->opnum
]);
6640 /* Determine the mode to reload in.
6641 See comments above (for input reloading). */
6643 if (mode
== VOIDmode
)
6645 /* VOIDmode should never happen for an output. */
6646 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn
)) < 0)
6647 /* It's the compiler's fault. */
6648 fatal_insn ("VOIDmode on an output", insn
);
6649 error_for_asm (insn
, "output operand is constant in `asm'");
6650 /* Prevent crash--use something we know is valid. */
6652 old
= gen_rtx_REG (mode
, REGNO (reloadreg
));
6655 if (GET_MODE (reloadreg
) != mode
)
6656 reloadreg
= gen_rtx_REG (mode
, REGNO (reloadreg
));
6658 #ifdef SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
6660 /* If we need two reload regs, set RELOADREG to the intermediate
6661 one, since it will be stored into OLD. We might need a secondary
6662 register only for an input reload, so check again here. */
6664 if (rl
->secondary_out_reload
>= 0)
6668 if (GET_CODE (old
) == REG
&& REGNO (old
) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6669 && reg_equiv_mem
[REGNO (old
)] != 0)
6670 real_old
= reg_equiv_mem
[REGNO (old
)];
6672 if ((SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rl
->class,
6676 rtx second_reloadreg
= reloadreg
;
6677 reloadreg
= rld
[rl
->secondary_out_reload
].reg_rtx
;
6679 /* See if RELOADREG is to be used as a scratch register
6680 or as an intermediate register. */
6681 if (rl
->secondary_out_icode
!= CODE_FOR_nothing
)
6683 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (rl
->secondary_out_icode
)
6684 (real_old
, second_reloadreg
, reloadreg
)));
6689 /* See if we need both a scratch and intermediate reload
6692 int secondary_reload
= rl
->secondary_out_reload
;
6693 enum insn_code tertiary_icode
6694 = rld
[secondary_reload
].secondary_out_icode
;
6696 if (GET_MODE (reloadreg
) != mode
)
6697 reloadreg
= gen_rtx_REG (mode
, REGNO (reloadreg
));
6699 if (tertiary_icode
!= CODE_FOR_nothing
)
6702 = rld
[rld
[secondary_reload
].secondary_out_reload
].reg_rtx
;
6705 /* Copy primary reload reg to secondary reload reg.
6706 (Note that these have been swapped above, then
6707 secondary reload reg to OLD using our insn.) */
6709 /* If REAL_OLD is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it
6710 and try to put the opposite SUBREG on
6712 if (GET_CODE (real_old
) == SUBREG
6713 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (real_old
))
6714 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (real_old
))))
6715 && 0 != (tem
= gen_lowpart_common
6716 (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (real_old
)),
6718 real_old
= SUBREG_REG (real_old
), reloadreg
= tem
;
6720 gen_reload (reloadreg
, second_reloadreg
,
6721 rl
->opnum
, rl
->when_needed
);
6722 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (tertiary_icode
)
6723 (real_old
, reloadreg
, third_reloadreg
)));
6728 /* Copy between the reload regs here and then to
6731 gen_reload (reloadreg
, second_reloadreg
,
6732 rl
->opnum
, rl
->when_needed
);
6738 /* Output the last reload insn. */
6743 /* Don't output the last reload if OLD is not the dest of
6744 INSN and is in the src and is clobbered by INSN. */
6745 if (! flag_expensive_optimizations
6746 || GET_CODE (old
) != REG
6747 || !(set
= single_set (insn
))
6748 || rtx_equal_p (old
, SET_DEST (set
))
6749 || !reg_mentioned_p (old
, SET_SRC (set
))
6750 || !regno_clobbered_p (REGNO (old
), insn
, rl
->mode
, 0))
6751 gen_reload (old
, reloadreg
, rl
->opnum
,
6755 /* Look at all insns we emitted, just to be safe. */
6756 for (p
= get_insns (); p
; p
= NEXT_INSN (p
))
6759 rtx pat
= PATTERN (p
);
6761 /* If this output reload doesn't come from a spill reg,
6762 clear any memory of reloaded copies of the pseudo reg.
6763 If this output reload comes from a spill reg,
6764 reg_has_output_reload will make this do nothing. */
6765 note_stores (pat
, forget_old_reloads_1
, NULL
);
6767 if (reg_mentioned_p (rl
->reg_rtx
, pat
))
6769 rtx set
= single_set (insn
);
6770 if (reload_spill_index
[j
] < 0
6772 && SET_SRC (set
) == rl
->reg_rtx
)
6774 int src
= REGNO (SET_SRC (set
));
6776 reload_spill_index
[j
] = src
;
6777 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload
, src
);
6778 if (find_regno_note (insn
, REG_DEAD
, src
))
6779 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died
, src
);
6781 if (REGNO (rl
->reg_rtx
) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
6783 int s
= rl
->secondary_out_reload
;
6784 set
= single_set (p
);
6785 /* If this reload copies only to the secondary reload
6786 register, the secondary reload does the actual
6788 if (s
>= 0 && set
== NULL_RTX
)
6789 /* We can't tell what function the secondary reload
6790 has and where the actual store to the pseudo is
6791 made; leave new_spill_reg_store alone. */
6794 && SET_SRC (set
) == rl
->reg_rtx
6795 && SET_DEST (set
) == rld
[s
].reg_rtx
)
6797 /* Usually the next instruction will be the
6798 secondary reload insn; if we can confirm
6799 that it is, setting new_spill_reg_store to
6800 that insn will allow an extra optimization. */
6801 rtx s_reg
= rld
[s
].reg_rtx
;
6802 rtx next
= NEXT_INSN (p
);
6803 rld
[s
].out
= rl
->out
;
6804 rld
[s
].out_reg
= rl
->out_reg
;
6805 set
= single_set (next
);
6806 if (set
&& SET_SRC (set
) == s_reg
6807 && ! new_spill_reg_store
[REGNO (s_reg
)])
6809 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload
,
6811 new_spill_reg_store
[REGNO (s_reg
)] = next
;
6815 new_spill_reg_store
[REGNO (rl
->reg_rtx
)] = p
;
6820 if (rl
->when_needed
== RELOAD_OTHER
)
6822 emit_insns (other_output_reload_insns
[rl
->opnum
]);
6823 other_output_reload_insns
[rl
->opnum
] = get_insns ();
6826 output_reload_insns
[rl
->opnum
] = get_insns ();
6828 if (flag_non_call_exceptions
)
6829 copy_eh_notes (insn
, get_insns ());
6834 /* Do input reloading for reload RL, which is for the insn described by CHAIN
6835 and has the number J. */
6837 do_input_reload (chain
, rl
, j
)
6838 struct insn_chain
*chain
;
6842 int expect_occurrences
= 1;
6843 rtx insn
= chain
->insn
;
6844 rtx old
= (rl
->in
&& GET_CODE (rl
->in
) == MEM
6845 ? rl
->in_reg
: rl
->in
);
6848 /* AUTO_INC reloads need to be handled even if inherited. We got an
6849 AUTO_INC reload if reload_out is set but reload_out_reg isn't. */
6850 && (! reload_inherited
[j
] || (rl
->out
&& ! rl
->out_reg
))
6851 && ! rtx_equal_p (rl
->reg_rtx
, old
)
6852 && rl
->reg_rtx
!= 0)
6853 emit_input_reload_insns (chain
, rld
+ j
, old
, j
);
6855 /* When inheriting a wider reload, we have a MEM in rl->in,
6856 e.g. inheriting a SImode output reload for
6857 (mem:HI (plus:SI (reg:SI 14 fp) (const_int 10))) */
6858 if (optimize
&& reload_inherited
[j
] && rl
->in
6859 && GET_CODE (rl
->in
) == MEM
6860 && GET_CODE (rl
->in_reg
) == MEM
6861 && reload_spill_index
[j
] >= 0
6862 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid
, reload_spill_index
[j
]))
6865 = count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn
), rl
->in
, 0) == 1 ? 0 : -1;
6866 rl
->in
= regno_reg_rtx
[reg_reloaded_contents
[reload_spill_index
[j
]]];
6869 /* If we are reloading a register that was recently stored in with an
6870 output-reload, see if we can prove there was
6871 actually no need to store the old value in it. */
6874 && (reload_inherited
[j
] || reload_override_in
[j
])
6876 && GET_CODE (rl
->reg_rtx
) == REG
6877 && spill_reg_store
[REGNO (rl
->reg_rtx
)] != 0
6879 /* There doesn't seem to be any reason to restrict this to pseudos
6880 and doing so loses in the case where we are copying from a
6881 register of the wrong class. */
6882 && (REGNO (spill_reg_stored_to
[REGNO (rl
->reg_rtx
)])
6883 >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
6885 /* The insn might have already some references to stackslots
6886 replaced by MEMs, while reload_out_reg still names the
6888 && (dead_or_set_p (insn
,
6889 spill_reg_stored_to
[REGNO (rl
->reg_rtx
)])
6890 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to
[REGNO (rl
->reg_rtx
)],
6892 delete_output_reload (insn
, j
, REGNO (rl
->reg_rtx
));
6895 /* Do output reloading for reload RL, which is for the insn described by
6896 CHAIN and has the number J.
6897 ??? At some point we need to support handling output reloads of
6898 JUMP_INSNs or insns that set cc0. */
6900 do_output_reload (chain
, rl
, j
)
6901 struct insn_chain
*chain
;
6906 rtx insn
= chain
->insn
;
6907 /* If this is an output reload that stores something that is
6908 not loaded in this same reload, see if we can eliminate a previous
6910 rtx pseudo
= rl
->out_reg
;
6914 && GET_CODE (pseudo
) == REG
6915 && ! rtx_equal_p (rl
->in_reg
, pseudo
)
6916 && REGNO (pseudo
) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6917 && reg_last_reload_reg
[REGNO (pseudo
)])
6919 int pseudo_no
= REGNO (pseudo
);
6920 int last_regno
= REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg
[pseudo_no
]);
6922 /* We don't need to test full validity of last_regno for
6923 inherit here; we only want to know if the store actually
6924 matches the pseudo. */
6925 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid
, last_regno
)
6926 && reg_reloaded_contents
[last_regno
] == pseudo_no
6927 && spill_reg_store
[last_regno
]
6928 && rtx_equal_p (pseudo
, spill_reg_stored_to
[last_regno
]))
6929 delete_output_reload (insn
, j
, last_regno
);
6934 || rl
->reg_rtx
== old
6935 || rl
->reg_rtx
== 0)
6938 /* An output operand that dies right away does need a reload,
6939 but need not be copied from it. Show the new location in the
6941 if ((GET_CODE (old
) == REG
|| GET_CODE (old
) == SCRATCH
)
6942 && (note
= find_reg_note (insn
, REG_UNUSED
, old
)) != 0)
6944 XEXP (note
, 0) = rl
->reg_rtx
;
6947 /* Likewise for a SUBREG of an operand that dies. */
6948 else if (GET_CODE (old
) == SUBREG
6949 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (old
)) == REG
6950 && 0 != (note
= find_reg_note (insn
, REG_UNUSED
,
6953 XEXP (note
, 0) = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (old
),
6957 else if (GET_CODE (old
) == SCRATCH
)
6958 /* If we aren't optimizing, there won't be a REG_UNUSED note,
6959 but we don't want to make an output reload. */
6962 /* If is a JUMP_INSN, we can't support output reloads yet. */
6963 if (GET_CODE (insn
) == JUMP_INSN
)
6966 emit_output_reload_insns (chain
, rld
+ j
, j
);
6969 /* Output insns to reload values in and out of the chosen reload regs. */
6972 emit_reload_insns (chain
)
6973 struct insn_chain
*chain
;
6975 rtx insn
= chain
->insn
;
6979 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_died
);
6981 for (j
= 0; j
< reload_n_operands
; j
++)
6982 input_reload_insns
[j
] = input_address_reload_insns
[j
]
6983 = inpaddr_address_reload_insns
[j
]
6984 = output_reload_insns
[j
] = output_address_reload_insns
[j
]
6985 = outaddr_address_reload_insns
[j
]
6986 = other_output_reload_insns
[j
] = 0;
6987 other_input_address_reload_insns
= 0;
6988 other_input_reload_insns
= 0;
6989 operand_reload_insns
= 0;
6990 other_operand_reload_insns
= 0;
6992 /* Dump reloads into the dump file. */
6995 fprintf (rtl_dump_file
, "\nReloads for insn # %d\n", INSN_UID (insn
));
6996 debug_reload_to_stream (rtl_dump_file
);
6999 /* Now output the instructions to copy the data into and out of the
7000 reload registers. Do these in the order that the reloads were reported,
7001 since reloads of base and index registers precede reloads of operands
7002 and the operands may need the base and index registers reloaded. */
7004 for (j
= 0; j
< n_reloads
; j
++)
7007 && REGNO (rld
[j
].reg_rtx
) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
7008 new_spill_reg_store
[REGNO (rld
[j
].reg_rtx
)] = 0;
7010 do_input_reload (chain
, rld
+ j
, j
);
7011 do_output_reload (chain
, rld
+ j
, j
);
7014 /* Now write all the insns we made for reloads in the order expected by
7015 the allocation functions. Prior to the insn being reloaded, we write
7016 the following reloads:
7018 RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reloads for input addresses.
7020 RELOAD_OTHER reloads.
7022 For each operand, any RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads followed
7023 by any RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS reloads followed by the
7024 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reload for the operand.
7026 RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDRS reloads.
7028 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads.
7030 After the insn being reloaded, we write the following:
7032 For each operand, any RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reloads followed
7033 by any RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload followed by the
7034 RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reload, followed by any RELOAD_OTHER output
7035 reloads for the operand. The RELOAD_OTHER output reloads are
7036 output in descending order by reload number. */
7038 emit_insns_before (other_input_address_reload_insns
, insn
);
7039 emit_insns_before (other_input_reload_insns
, insn
);
7041 for (j
= 0; j
< reload_n_operands
; j
++)
7043 emit_insns_before (inpaddr_address_reload_insns
[j
], insn
);
7044 emit_insns_before (input_address_reload_insns
[j
], insn
);
7045 emit_insns_before (input_reload_insns
[j
], insn
);
7048 emit_insns_before (other_operand_reload_insns
, insn
);
7049 emit_insns_before (operand_reload_insns
, insn
);
7051 for (j
= 0; j
< reload_n_operands
; j
++)
7053 rtx x
= emit_insns_after (outaddr_address_reload_insns
[j
], insn
);
7054 x
= emit_insns_after (output_address_reload_insns
[j
], x
);
7055 x
= emit_insns_after (output_reload_insns
[j
], x
);
7056 emit_insns_after (other_output_reload_insns
[j
], x
);
7059 /* For all the spill regs newly reloaded in this instruction,
7060 record what they were reloaded from, so subsequent instructions
7061 can inherit the reloads.
7063 Update spill_reg_store for the reloads of this insn.
7064 Copy the elements that were updated in the loop above. */
7066 for (j
= 0; j
< n_reloads
; j
++)
7068 int r
= reload_order
[j
];
7069 int i
= reload_spill_index
[r
];
7071 /* If this is a non-inherited input reload from a pseudo, we must
7072 clear any memory of a previous store to the same pseudo. Only do
7073 something if there will not be an output reload for the pseudo
7075 if (rld
[r
].in_reg
!= 0
7076 && ! (reload_inherited
[r
] || reload_override_in
[r
]))
7078 rtx reg
= rld
[r
].in_reg
;
7080 if (GET_CODE (reg
) == SUBREG
)
7081 reg
= SUBREG_REG (reg
);
7083 if (GET_CODE (reg
) == REG
7084 && REGNO (reg
) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7085 && ! reg_has_output_reload
[REGNO (reg
)])
7087 int nregno
= REGNO (reg
);
7089 if (reg_last_reload_reg
[nregno
])
7091 int last_regno
= REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg
[nregno
]);
7093 if (reg_reloaded_contents
[last_regno
] == nregno
)
7094 spill_reg_store
[last_regno
] = 0;
7099 /* I is nonneg if this reload used a register.
7100 If rld[r].reg_rtx is 0, this is an optional reload
7101 that we opted to ignore. */
7103 if (i
>= 0 && rld
[r
].reg_rtx
!= 0)
7105 int nr
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i
, GET_MODE (rld
[r
].reg_rtx
));
7107 int part_reaches_end
= 0;
7108 int all_reaches_end
= 1;
7110 /* For a multi register reload, we need to check if all or part
7111 of the value lives to the end. */
7112 for (k
= 0; k
< nr
; k
++)
7114 if (reload_reg_reaches_end_p (i
+ k
, rld
[r
].opnum
,
7115 rld
[r
].when_needed
))
7116 part_reaches_end
= 1;
7118 all_reaches_end
= 0;
7121 /* Ignore reloads that don't reach the end of the insn in
7123 if (all_reaches_end
)
7125 /* First, clear out memory of what used to be in this spill reg.
7126 If consecutive registers are used, clear them all. */
7128 for (k
= 0; k
< nr
; k
++)
7129 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid
, i
+ k
);
7131 /* Maybe the spill reg contains a copy of reload_out. */
7133 && (GET_CODE (rld
[r
].out
) == REG
7137 || GET_CODE (rld
[r
].out_reg
) == REG
))
7139 rtx out
= (GET_CODE (rld
[r
].out
) == REG
7143 /* AUTO_INC */ : XEXP (rld
[r
].in_reg
, 0));
7144 int nregno
= REGNO (out
);
7145 int nnr
= (nregno
>= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
? 1
7146 : HARD_REGNO_NREGS (nregno
,
7147 GET_MODE (rld
[r
].reg_rtx
)));
7149 spill_reg_store
[i
] = new_spill_reg_store
[i
];
7150 spill_reg_stored_to
[i
] = out
;
7151 reg_last_reload_reg
[nregno
] = rld
[r
].reg_rtx
;
7153 /* If NREGNO is a hard register, it may occupy more than
7154 one register. If it does, say what is in the
7155 rest of the registers assuming that both registers
7156 agree on how many words the object takes. If not,
7157 invalidate the subsequent registers. */
7159 if (nregno
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
7160 for (k
= 1; k
< nnr
; k
++)
7161 reg_last_reload_reg
[nregno
+ k
]
7163 ? gen_rtx_REG (reg_raw_mode
[REGNO (rld
[r
].reg_rtx
) + k
],
7164 REGNO (rld
[r
].reg_rtx
) + k
)
7167 /* Now do the inverse operation. */
7168 for (k
= 0; k
< nr
; k
++)
7170 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead
, i
+ k
);
7171 reg_reloaded_contents
[i
+ k
]
7172 = (nregno
>= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|| nr
!= nnr
7175 reg_reloaded_insn
[i
+ k
] = insn
;
7176 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid
, i
+ k
);
7180 /* Maybe the spill reg contains a copy of reload_in. Only do
7181 something if there will not be an output reload for
7182 the register being reloaded. */
7183 else if (rld
[r
].out_reg
== 0
7185 && ((GET_CODE (rld
[r
].in
) == REG
7186 && REGNO (rld
[r
].in
) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7187 && ! reg_has_output_reload
[REGNO (rld
[r
].in
)])
7188 || (GET_CODE (rld
[r
].in_reg
) == REG
7189 && ! reg_has_output_reload
[REGNO (rld
[r
].in_reg
)]))
7190 && ! reg_set_p (rld
[r
].reg_rtx
, PATTERN (insn
)))
7195 if (GET_CODE (rld
[r
].in
) == REG
7196 && REGNO (rld
[r
].in
) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
7197 nregno
= REGNO (rld
[r
].in
);
7198 else if (GET_CODE (rld
[r
].in_reg
) == REG
)
7199 nregno
= REGNO (rld
[r
].in_reg
);
7201 nregno
= REGNO (XEXP (rld
[r
].in_reg
, 0));
7203 nnr
= (nregno
>= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
? 1
7204 : HARD_REGNO_NREGS (nregno
,
7205 GET_MODE (rld
[r
].reg_rtx
)));
7207 reg_last_reload_reg
[nregno
] = rld
[r
].reg_rtx
;
7209 if (nregno
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
7210 for (k
= 1; k
< nnr
; k
++)
7211 reg_last_reload_reg
[nregno
+ k
]
7213 ? gen_rtx_REG (reg_raw_mode
[REGNO (rld
[r
].reg_rtx
) + k
],
7214 REGNO (rld
[r
].reg_rtx
) + k
)
7217 /* Unless we inherited this reload, show we haven't
7218 recently done a store.
7219 Previous stores of inherited auto_inc expressions
7220 also have to be discarded. */
7221 if (! reload_inherited
[r
]
7222 || (rld
[r
].out
&& ! rld
[r
].out_reg
))
7223 spill_reg_store
[i
] = 0;
7225 for (k
= 0; k
< nr
; k
++)
7227 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead
, i
+ k
);
7228 reg_reloaded_contents
[i
+ k
]
7229 = (nregno
>= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|| nr
!= nnr
7232 reg_reloaded_insn
[i
+ k
] = insn
;
7233 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid
, i
+ k
);
7238 /* However, if part of the reload reaches the end, then we must
7239 invalidate the old info for the part that survives to the end. */
7240 else if (part_reaches_end
)
7242 for (k
= 0; k
< nr
; k
++)
7243 if (reload_reg_reaches_end_p (i
+ k
,
7245 rld
[r
].when_needed
))
7246 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid
, i
+ k
);
7250 /* The following if-statement was #if 0'd in 1.34 (or before...).
7251 It's reenabled in 1.35 because supposedly nothing else
7252 deals with this problem. */
7254 /* If a register gets output-reloaded from a non-spill register,
7255 that invalidates any previous reloaded copy of it.
7256 But forget_old_reloads_1 won't get to see it, because
7257 it thinks only about the original insn. So invalidate it here. */
7258 if (i
< 0 && rld
[r
].out
!= 0
7259 && (GET_CODE (rld
[r
].out
) == REG
7260 || (GET_CODE (rld
[r
].out
) == MEM
7261 && GET_CODE (rld
[r
].out_reg
) == REG
)))
7263 rtx out
= (GET_CODE (rld
[r
].out
) == REG
7264 ? rld
[r
].out
: rld
[r
].out_reg
);
7265 int nregno
= REGNO (out
);
7266 if (nregno
>= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
7268 rtx src_reg
, store_insn
= NULL_RTX
;
7270 reg_last_reload_reg
[nregno
] = 0;
7272 /* If we can find a hard register that is stored, record
7273 the storing insn so that we may delete this insn with
7274 delete_output_reload. */
7275 src_reg
= rld
[r
].reg_rtx
;
7277 /* If this is an optional reload, try to find the source reg
7278 from an input reload. */
7281 rtx set
= single_set (insn
);
7282 if (set
&& SET_DEST (set
) == rld
[r
].out
)
7286 src_reg
= SET_SRC (set
);
7288 for (k
= 0; k
< n_reloads
; k
++)
7290 if (rld
[k
].in
== src_reg
)
7292 src_reg
= rld
[k
].reg_rtx
;
7299 store_insn
= new_spill_reg_store
[REGNO (src_reg
)];
7300 if (src_reg
&& GET_CODE (src_reg
) == REG
7301 && REGNO (src_reg
) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
7303 int src_regno
= REGNO (src_reg
);
7304 int nr
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (src_regno
, rld
[r
].mode
);
7305 /* The place where to find a death note varies with
7306 PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P . The condition is not
7307 necessarily checked exactly in the code that moves
7308 notes, so just check both locations. */
7309 rtx note
= find_regno_note (insn
, REG_DEAD
, src_regno
);
7310 if (! note
&& store_insn
)
7311 note
= find_regno_note (store_insn
, REG_DEAD
, src_regno
);
7314 spill_reg_store
[src_regno
+ nr
] = store_insn
;
7315 spill_reg_stored_to
[src_regno
+ nr
] = out
;
7316 reg_reloaded_contents
[src_regno
+ nr
] = nregno
;
7317 reg_reloaded_insn
[src_regno
+ nr
] = store_insn
;
7318 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead
, src_regno
+ nr
);
7319 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid
, src_regno
+ nr
);
7320 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload
, src_regno
+ nr
);
7322 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died
, src_regno
);
7324 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died
, src_regno
);
7326 reg_last_reload_reg
[nregno
] = src_reg
;
7331 int num_regs
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (nregno
, GET_MODE (rld
[r
].out
));
7333 while (num_regs
-- > 0)
7334 reg_last_reload_reg
[nregno
+ num_regs
] = 0;
7338 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_dead
, reg_reloaded_died
);
7341 /* Emit code to perform a reload from IN (which may be a reload register) to
7342 OUT (which may also be a reload register). IN or OUT is from operand
7343 OPNUM with reload type TYPE.
7345 Returns first insn emitted. */
7348 gen_reload (out
, in
, opnum
, type
)
7352 enum reload_type type
;
7354 rtx last
= get_last_insn ();
7357 /* If IN is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it and try to put the
7358 opposite SUBREG on OUT. Likewise for a paradoxical SUBREG on OUT. */
7359 if (GET_CODE (in
) == SUBREG
7360 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (in
))
7361 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in
))))
7362 && (tem
= gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in
)), out
)) != 0)
7363 in
= SUBREG_REG (in
), out
= tem
;
7364 else if (GET_CODE (out
) == SUBREG
7365 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (out
))
7366 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (out
))))
7367 && (tem
= gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (out
)), in
)) != 0)
7368 out
= SUBREG_REG (out
), in
= tem
;
7370 /* How to do this reload can get quite tricky. Normally, we are being
7371 asked to reload a simple operand, such as a MEM, a constant, or a pseudo
7372 register that didn't get a hard register. In that case we can just
7373 call emit_move_insn.
7375 We can also be asked to reload a PLUS that adds a register or a MEM to
7376 another register, constant or MEM. This can occur during frame pointer
7377 elimination and while reloading addresses. This case is handled by
7378 trying to emit a single insn to perform the add. If it is not valid,
7379 we use a two insn sequence.
7381 Finally, we could be called to handle an 'o' constraint by putting
7382 an address into a register. In that case, we first try to do this
7383 with a named pattern of "reload_load_address". If no such pattern
7384 exists, we just emit a SET insn and hope for the best (it will normally
7385 be valid on machines that use 'o').
7387 This entire process is made complex because reload will never
7388 process the insns we generate here and so we must ensure that
7389 they will fit their constraints and also by the fact that parts of
7390 IN might be being reloaded separately and replaced with spill registers.
7391 Because of this, we are, in some sense, just guessing the right approach
7392 here. The one listed above seems to work.
7394 ??? At some point, this whole thing needs to be rethought. */
7396 if (GET_CODE (in
) == PLUS
7397 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (in
, 0)) == REG
7398 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in
, 0)) == SUBREG
7399 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in
, 0)) == MEM
)
7400 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (in
, 1)) == REG
7401 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in
, 1)) == SUBREG
7402 || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (in
, 1))
7403 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in
, 1)) == MEM
))
7405 /* We need to compute the sum of a register or a MEM and another
7406 register, constant, or MEM, and put it into the reload
7407 register. The best possible way of doing this is if the machine
7408 has a three-operand ADD insn that accepts the required operands.
7410 The simplest approach is to try to generate such an insn and see if it
7411 is recognized and matches its constraints. If so, it can be used.
7413 It might be better not to actually emit the insn unless it is valid,
7414 but we need to pass the insn as an operand to `recog' and
7415 `extract_insn' and it is simpler to emit and then delete the insn if
7416 not valid than to dummy things up. */
7418 rtx op0
, op1
, tem
, insn
;
7421 op0
= find_replacement (&XEXP (in
, 0));
7422 op1
= find_replacement (&XEXP (in
, 1));
7424 /* Since constraint checking is strict, commutativity won't be
7425 checked, so we need to do that here to avoid spurious failure
7426 if the add instruction is two-address and the second operand
7427 of the add is the same as the reload reg, which is frequently
7428 the case. If the insn would be A = B + A, rearrange it so
7429 it will be A = A + B as constrain_operands expects. */
7431 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (in
, 1)) == REG
7432 && REGNO (out
) == REGNO (XEXP (in
, 1)))
7433 tem
= op0
, op0
= op1
, op1
= tem
;
7435 if (op0
!= XEXP (in
, 0) || op1
!= XEXP (in
, 1))
7436 in
= gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (in
), op0
, op1
);
7438 insn
= emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode
, out
, in
));
7439 code
= recog_memoized (insn
);
7443 extract_insn (insn
);
7444 /* We want constrain operands to treat this insn strictly in
7445 its validity determination, i.e., the way it would after reload
7447 if (constrain_operands (1))
7451 delete_insns_since (last
);
7453 /* If that failed, we must use a conservative two-insn sequence.
7455 Use a move to copy one operand into the reload register. Prefer
7456 to reload a constant, MEM or pseudo since the move patterns can
7457 handle an arbitrary operand. If OP1 is not a constant, MEM or
7458 pseudo and OP1 is not a valid operand for an add instruction, then
7461 After reloading one of the operands into the reload register, add
7462 the reload register to the output register.
7464 If there is another way to do this for a specific machine, a
7465 DEFINE_PEEPHOLE should be specified that recognizes the sequence
7468 code
= (int) add_optab
->handlers
[(int) GET_MODE (out
)].insn_code
;
7470 if (CONSTANT_P (op1
) || GET_CODE (op1
) == MEM
|| GET_CODE (op1
) == SUBREG
7471 || (GET_CODE (op1
) == REG
7472 && REGNO (op1
) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
7473 || (code
!= CODE_FOR_nothing
7474 && ! ((*insn_data
[code
].operand
[2].predicate
)
7475 (op1
, insn_data
[code
].operand
[2].mode
))))
7476 tem
= op0
, op0
= op1
, op1
= tem
;
7478 gen_reload (out
, op0
, opnum
, type
);
7480 /* If OP0 and OP1 are the same, we can use OUT for OP1.
7481 This fixes a problem on the 32K where the stack pointer cannot
7482 be used as an operand of an add insn. */
7484 if (rtx_equal_p (op0
, op1
))
7487 insn
= emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (out
, op1
));
7489 /* If that failed, copy the address register to the reload register.
7490 Then add the constant to the reload register. */
7492 code
= recog_memoized (insn
);
7496 extract_insn (insn
);
7497 /* We want constrain operands to treat this insn strictly in
7498 its validity determination, i.e., the way it would after reload
7500 if (constrain_operands (1))
7502 /* Add a REG_EQUIV note so that find_equiv_reg can find it. */
7504 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV
, in
, REG_NOTES (insn
));
7509 delete_insns_since (last
);
7511 gen_reload (out
, op1
, opnum
, type
);
7512 insn
= emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (out
, op0
));
7513 REG_NOTES (insn
) = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV
, in
, REG_NOTES (insn
));
7516 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
7517 /* If we need a memory location to do the move, do it that way. */
7518 else if (GET_CODE (in
) == REG
&& REGNO (in
) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7519 && GET_CODE (out
) == REG
&& REGNO (out
) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7520 && SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (in
)),
7521 REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (out
)),
7524 /* Get the memory to use and rewrite both registers to its mode. */
7525 rtx loc
= get_secondary_mem (in
, GET_MODE (out
), opnum
, type
);
7527 if (GET_MODE (loc
) != GET_MODE (out
))
7528 out
= gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (loc
), REGNO (out
));
7530 if (GET_MODE (loc
) != GET_MODE (in
))
7531 in
= gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (loc
), REGNO (in
));
7533 gen_reload (loc
, in
, opnum
, type
);
7534 gen_reload (out
, loc
, opnum
, type
);
7538 /* If IN is a simple operand, use gen_move_insn. */
7539 else if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (in
)) == 'o' || GET_CODE (in
) == SUBREG
)
7540 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (out
, in
));
7542 #ifdef HAVE_reload_load_address
7543 else if (HAVE_reload_load_address
)
7544 emit_insn (gen_reload_load_address (out
, in
));
7547 /* Otherwise, just write (set OUT IN) and hope for the best. */
7549 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode
, out
, in
));
7551 /* Return the first insn emitted.
7552 We can not just return get_last_insn, because there may have
7553 been multiple instructions emitted. Also note that gen_move_insn may
7554 emit more than one insn itself, so we can not assume that there is one
7555 insn emitted per emit_insn_before call. */
7557 return last
? NEXT_INSN (last
) : get_insns ();
7560 /* Delete a previously made output-reload whose result we now believe
7561 is not needed. First we double-check.
7563 INSN is the insn now being processed.
7564 LAST_RELOAD_REG is the hard register number for which we want to delete
7565 the last output reload.
7566 J is the reload-number that originally used REG. The caller has made
7567 certain that reload J doesn't use REG any longer for input. */
7570 delete_output_reload (insn
, j
, last_reload_reg
)
7573 int last_reload_reg
;
7575 rtx output_reload_insn
= spill_reg_store
[last_reload_reg
];
7576 rtx reg
= spill_reg_stored_to
[last_reload_reg
];
7579 int n_inherited
= 0;
7583 /* Get the raw pseudo-register referred to. */
7585 while (GET_CODE (reg
) == SUBREG
)
7586 reg
= SUBREG_REG (reg
);
7587 substed
= reg_equiv_memory_loc
[REGNO (reg
)];
7589 /* This is unsafe if the operand occurs more often in the current
7590 insn than it is inherited. */
7591 for (k
= n_reloads
- 1; k
>= 0; k
--)
7593 rtx reg2
= rld
[k
].in
;
7596 if (GET_CODE (reg2
) == MEM
|| reload_override_in
[k
])
7597 reg2
= rld
[k
].in_reg
;
7599 if (rld
[k
].out
&& ! rld
[k
].out_reg
)
7600 reg2
= XEXP (rld
[k
].in_reg
, 0);
7602 while (GET_CODE (reg2
) == SUBREG
)
7603 reg2
= SUBREG_REG (reg2
);
7604 if (rtx_equal_p (reg2
, reg
))
7606 if (reload_inherited
[k
] || reload_override_in
[k
] || k
== j
)
7609 reg2
= rld
[k
].out_reg
;
7612 while (GET_CODE (reg2
) == SUBREG
)
7613 reg2
= XEXP (reg2
, 0);
7614 if (rtx_equal_p (reg2
, reg
))
7621 n_occurrences
= count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn
), reg
, 0);
7623 n_occurrences
+= count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn
),
7624 eliminate_regs (substed
, 0,
7626 if (n_occurrences
> n_inherited
)
7629 /* If the pseudo-reg we are reloading is no longer referenced
7630 anywhere between the store into it and here,
7631 and no jumps or labels intervene, then the value can get
7632 here through the reload reg alone.
7633 Otherwise, give up--return. */
7634 for (i1
= NEXT_INSN (output_reload_insn
);
7635 i1
!= insn
; i1
= NEXT_INSN (i1
))
7637 if (GET_CODE (i1
) == CODE_LABEL
|| GET_CODE (i1
) == JUMP_INSN
)
7639 if ((GET_CODE (i1
) == INSN
|| GET_CODE (i1
) == CALL_INSN
)
7640 && reg_mentioned_p (reg
, PATTERN (i1
)))
7642 /* If this is USE in front of INSN, we only have to check that
7643 there are no more references than accounted for by inheritance. */
7644 while (GET_CODE (i1
) == INSN
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (i1
)) == USE
)
7646 n_occurrences
+= rtx_equal_p (reg
, XEXP (PATTERN (i1
), 0)) != 0;
7647 i1
= NEXT_INSN (i1
);
7649 if (n_occurrences
<= n_inherited
&& i1
== insn
)
7655 /* We will be deleting the insn. Remove the spill reg information. */
7656 for (k
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (last_reload_reg
, GET_MODE (reg
)); k
-- > 0; )
7658 spill_reg_store
[last_reload_reg
+ k
] = 0;
7659 spill_reg_stored_to
[last_reload_reg
+ k
] = 0;
7662 /* The caller has already checked that REG dies or is set in INSN.
7663 It has also checked that we are optimizing, and thus some
7664 inaccurancies in the debugging information are acceptable.
7665 So we could just delete output_reload_insn. But in some cases
7666 we can improve the debugging information without sacrificing
7667 optimization - maybe even improving the code: See if the pseudo
7668 reg has been completely replaced with reload regs. If so, delete
7669 the store insn and forget we had a stack slot for the pseudo. */
7670 if (rld
[j
].out
!= rld
[j
].in
7671 && REG_N_DEATHS (REGNO (reg
)) == 1
7672 && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (reg
)) == 1
7673 && REG_BASIC_BLOCK (REGNO (reg
)) >= 0
7674 && find_regno_note (insn
, REG_DEAD
, REGNO (reg
)))
7678 /* We know that it was used only between here and the beginning of
7679 the current basic block. (We also know that the last use before
7680 INSN was the output reload we are thinking of deleting, but never
7681 mind that.) Search that range; see if any ref remains. */
7682 for (i2
= PREV_INSN (insn
); i2
; i2
= PREV_INSN (i2
))
7684 rtx set
= single_set (i2
);
7686 /* Uses which just store in the pseudo don't count,
7687 since if they are the only uses, they are dead. */
7688 if (set
!= 0 && SET_DEST (set
) == reg
)
7690 if (GET_CODE (i2
) == CODE_LABEL
7691 || GET_CODE (i2
) == JUMP_INSN
)
7693 if ((GET_CODE (i2
) == INSN
|| GET_CODE (i2
) == CALL_INSN
)
7694 && reg_mentioned_p (reg
, PATTERN (i2
)))
7696 /* Some other ref remains; just delete the output reload we
7698 delete_address_reloads (output_reload_insn
, insn
);
7699 delete_insn (output_reload_insn
);
7704 /* Delete the now-dead stores into this pseudo. Note that this
7705 loop also takes care of deleting output_reload_insn. */
7706 for (i2
= PREV_INSN (insn
); i2
; i2
= PREV_INSN (i2
))
7708 rtx set
= single_set (i2
);
7710 if (set
!= 0 && SET_DEST (set
) == reg
)
7712 delete_address_reloads (i2
, insn
);
7715 if (GET_CODE (i2
) == CODE_LABEL
7716 || GET_CODE (i2
) == JUMP_INSN
)
7720 /* For the debugging info, say the pseudo lives in this reload reg. */
7721 reg_renumber
[REGNO (reg
)] = REGNO (rld
[j
].reg_rtx
);
7722 alter_reg (REGNO (reg
), -1);
7726 delete_address_reloads (output_reload_insn
, insn
);
7727 delete_insn (output_reload_insn
);
7731 /* We are going to delete DEAD_INSN. Recursively delete loads of
7732 reload registers used in DEAD_INSN that are not used till CURRENT_INSN.
7733 CURRENT_INSN is being reloaded, so we have to check its reloads too. */
7735 delete_address_reloads (dead_insn
, current_insn
)
7736 rtx dead_insn
, current_insn
;
7738 rtx set
= single_set (dead_insn
);
7739 rtx set2
, dst
, prev
, next
;
7742 rtx dst
= SET_DEST (set
);
7743 if (GET_CODE (dst
) == MEM
)
7744 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn
, XEXP (dst
, 0), current_insn
);
7746 /* If we deleted the store from a reloaded post_{in,de}c expression,
7747 we can delete the matching adds. */
7748 prev
= PREV_INSN (dead_insn
);
7749 next
= NEXT_INSN (dead_insn
);
7750 if (! prev
|| ! next
)
7752 set
= single_set (next
);
7753 set2
= single_set (prev
);
7755 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set
)) != PLUS
|| GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set2
)) != PLUS
7756 || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set
), 1)) != CONST_INT
7757 || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2
), 1)) != CONST_INT
)
7759 dst
= SET_DEST (set
);
7760 if (! rtx_equal_p (dst
, SET_DEST (set2
))
7761 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst
, XEXP (SET_SRC (set
), 0))
7762 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst
, XEXP (SET_SRC (set2
), 0))
7763 || (INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set
), 1))
7764 != -INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2
), 1))))
7766 delete_related_insns (prev
);
7767 delete_related_insns (next
);
7770 /* Subfunction of delete_address_reloads: process registers found in X. */
7772 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn
, x
, current_insn
)
7773 rtx dead_insn
, x
, current_insn
;
7775 rtx prev
, set
, dst
, i2
;
7777 enum rtx_code code
= GET_CODE (x
);
7781 const char *fmt
= GET_RTX_FORMAT (code
);
7782 for (i
= GET_RTX_LENGTH (code
) - 1; i
>= 0; i
--)
7785 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn
, XEXP (x
, i
), current_insn
);
7786 else if (fmt
[i
] == 'E')
7788 for (j
= XVECLEN (x
, i
) - 1; j
>= 0; j
--)
7789 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn
, XVECEXP (x
, i
, j
),
7796 if (spill_reg_order
[REGNO (x
)] < 0)
7799 /* Scan backwards for the insn that sets x. This might be a way back due
7801 for (prev
= PREV_INSN (dead_insn
); prev
; prev
= PREV_INSN (prev
))
7803 code
= GET_CODE (prev
);
7804 if (code
== CODE_LABEL
|| code
== JUMP_INSN
)
7806 if (GET_RTX_CLASS (code
) != 'i')
7808 if (reg_set_p (x
, PATTERN (prev
)))
7810 if (reg_referenced_p (x
, PATTERN (prev
)))
7813 if (! prev
|| INSN_UID (prev
) < reload_first_uid
)
7815 /* Check that PREV only sets the reload register. */
7816 set
= single_set (prev
);
7819 dst
= SET_DEST (set
);
7820 if (GET_CODE (dst
) != REG
7821 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst
, x
))
7823 if (! reg_set_p (dst
, PATTERN (dead_insn
)))
7825 /* Check if DST was used in a later insn -
7826 it might have been inherited. */
7827 for (i2
= NEXT_INSN (dead_insn
); i2
; i2
= NEXT_INSN (i2
))
7829 if (GET_CODE (i2
) == CODE_LABEL
)
7833 if (reg_referenced_p (dst
, PATTERN (i2
)))
7835 /* If there is a reference to the register in the current insn,
7836 it might be loaded in a non-inherited reload. If no other
7837 reload uses it, that means the register is set before
7839 if (i2
== current_insn
)
7841 for (j
= n_reloads
- 1; j
>= 0; j
--)
7842 if ((rld
[j
].reg_rtx
== dst
&& reload_inherited
[j
])
7843 || reload_override_in
[j
] == dst
)
7845 for (j
= n_reloads
- 1; j
>= 0; j
--)
7846 if (rld
[j
].in
&& rld
[j
].reg_rtx
== dst
)
7853 if (GET_CODE (i2
) == JUMP_INSN
)
7855 /* If DST is still live at CURRENT_INSN, check if it is used for
7856 any reload. Note that even if CURRENT_INSN sets DST, we still
7857 have to check the reloads. */
7858 if (i2
== current_insn
)
7860 for (j
= n_reloads
- 1; j
>= 0; j
--)
7861 if ((rld
[j
].reg_rtx
== dst
&& reload_inherited
[j
])
7862 || reload_override_in
[j
] == dst
)
7864 /* ??? We can't finish the loop here, because dst might be
7865 allocated to a pseudo in this block if no reload in this
7866 block needs any of the clsses containing DST - see
7867 spill_hard_reg. There is no easy way to tell this, so we
7868 have to scan till the end of the basic block. */
7870 if (reg_set_p (dst
, PATTERN (i2
)))
7874 delete_address_reloads_1 (prev
, SET_SRC (set
), current_insn
);
7875 reg_reloaded_contents
[REGNO (dst
)] = -1;
7879 /* Output reload-insns to reload VALUE into RELOADREG.
7880 VALUE is an autoincrement or autodecrement RTX whose operand
7881 is a register or memory location;
7882 so reloading involves incrementing that location.
7883 IN is either identical to VALUE, or some cheaper place to reload from.
7885 INC_AMOUNT is the number to increment or decrement by (always positive).
7886 This cannot be deduced from VALUE.
7888 Return the instruction that stores into RELOADREG. */
7891 inc_for_reload (reloadreg
, in
, value
, inc_amount
)
7896 /* REG or MEM to be copied and incremented. */
7897 rtx incloc
= XEXP (value
, 0);
7898 /* Nonzero if increment after copying. */
7899 int post
= (GET_CODE (value
) == POST_DEC
|| GET_CODE (value
) == POST_INC
);
7905 rtx real_in
= in
== value
? XEXP (in
, 0) : in
;
7907 /* No hard register is equivalent to this register after
7908 inc/dec operation. If REG_LAST_RELOAD_REG were non-zero,
7909 we could inc/dec that register as well (maybe even using it for
7910 the source), but I'm not sure it's worth worrying about. */
7911 if (GET_CODE (incloc
) == REG
)
7912 reg_last_reload_reg
[REGNO (incloc
)] = 0;
7914 if (GET_CODE (value
) == PRE_DEC
|| GET_CODE (value
) == POST_DEC
)
7915 inc_amount
= -inc_amount
;
7917 inc
= GEN_INT (inc_amount
);
7919 /* If this is post-increment, first copy the location to the reload reg. */
7920 if (post
&& real_in
!= reloadreg
)
7921 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg
, real_in
));
7925 /* See if we can directly increment INCLOC. Use a method similar to
7926 that in gen_reload. */
7928 last
= get_last_insn ();
7929 add_insn
= emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode
, incloc
,
7930 gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (incloc
),
7933 code
= recog_memoized (add_insn
);
7936 extract_insn (add_insn
);
7937 if (constrain_operands (1))
7939 /* If this is a pre-increment and we have incremented the value
7940 where it lives, copy the incremented value to RELOADREG to
7941 be used as an address. */
7944 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg
, incloc
));
7949 delete_insns_since (last
);
7952 /* If couldn't do the increment directly, must increment in RELOADREG.
7953 The way we do this depends on whether this is pre- or post-increment.
7954 For pre-increment, copy INCLOC to the reload register, increment it
7955 there, then save back. */
7959 if (in
!= reloadreg
)
7960 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg
, real_in
));
7961 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg
, inc
));
7962 store
= emit_insn (gen_move_insn (incloc
, reloadreg
));
7967 Because this might be a jump insn or a compare, and because RELOADREG
7968 may not be available after the insn in an input reload, we must do
7969 the incrementation before the insn being reloaded for.
7971 We have already copied IN to RELOADREG. Increment the copy in
7972 RELOADREG, save that back, then decrement RELOADREG so it has
7973 the original value. */
7975 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg
, inc
));
7976 store
= emit_insn (gen_move_insn (incloc
, reloadreg
));
7977 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg
, GEN_INT (-inc_amount
)));
7983 /* Return 1 if we are certain that the constraint-string STRING allows
7984 the hard register REG. Return 0 if we can't be sure of this. */
7987 constraint_accepts_reg_p (string
, reg
)
7992 int regno
= true_regnum (reg
);
7995 /* Initialize for first alternative. */
7997 /* Check that each alternative contains `g' or `r'. */
7999 switch (c
= *string
++)
8002 /* If an alternative lacks `g' or `r', we lose. */
8005 /* If an alternative lacks `g' or `r', we lose. */
8008 /* Initialize for next alternative. */
8013 /* Any general reg wins for this alternative. */
8014 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents
[(int) GENERAL_REGS
], regno
))
8018 /* Any reg in specified class wins for this alternative. */
8020 enum reg_class
class = REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (c
);
8022 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents
[(int) class], regno
))
8028 /* INSN is a no-op; delete it.
8029 If this sets the return value of the function, we must keep a USE around,
8030 in case this is in a different basic block than the final USE. Otherwise,
8031 we could loose important register lifeness information on
8032 SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES machines, where return registers might be used as
8033 spills: subsequent passes assume that spill registers are dead at the end
8035 VALUE must be the return value in such a case, NULL otherwise. */
8037 reload_cse_delete_noop_set (insn
, value
)
8040 bool purge
= BLOCK_FOR_INSN (insn
)->end
== insn
;
8043 PATTERN (insn
) = gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode
, value
);
8044 INSN_CODE (insn
) = -1;
8045 REG_NOTES (insn
) = NULL_RTX
;
8050 purge_dead_edges (BLOCK_FOR_INSN (insn
));
8053 /* See whether a single set SET is a noop. */
8055 reload_cse_noop_set_p (set
)
8058 return rtx_equal_for_cselib_p (SET_DEST (set
), SET_SRC (set
));
8061 /* Try to simplify INSN. */
8063 reload_cse_simplify (insn
)
8066 rtx body
= PATTERN (insn
);
8068 if (GET_CODE (body
) == SET
)
8072 /* Simplify even if we may think it is a no-op.
8073 We may think a memory load of a value smaller than WORD_SIZE
8074 is redundant because we haven't taken into account possible
8075 implicit extension. reload_cse_simplify_set() will bring
8076 this out, so it's safer to simplify before we delete. */
8077 count
+= reload_cse_simplify_set (body
, insn
);
8079 if (!count
&& reload_cse_noop_set_p (body
))
8081 rtx value
= SET_DEST (body
);
8083 && ! REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (value
))
8085 reload_cse_delete_noop_set (insn
, value
);
8090 apply_change_group ();
8092 reload_cse_simplify_operands (insn
);
8094 else if (GET_CODE (body
) == PARALLEL
)
8098 rtx value
= NULL_RTX
;
8100 /* If every action in a PARALLEL is a noop, we can delete
8101 the entire PARALLEL. */
8102 for (i
= XVECLEN (body
, 0) - 1; i
>= 0; --i
)
8104 rtx part
= XVECEXP (body
, 0, i
);
8105 if (GET_CODE (part
) == SET
)
8107 if (! reload_cse_noop_set_p (part
))
8109 if (REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (SET_DEST (part
)))
8113 value
= SET_DEST (part
);
8116 else if (GET_CODE (part
) != CLOBBER
)
8122 reload_cse_delete_noop_set (insn
, value
);
8123 /* We're done with this insn. */
8127 /* It's not a no-op, but we can try to simplify it. */
8128 for (i
= XVECLEN (body
, 0) - 1; i
>= 0; --i
)
8129 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (body
, 0, i
)) == SET
)
8130 count
+= reload_cse_simplify_set (XVECEXP (body
, 0, i
), insn
);
8133 apply_change_group ();
8135 reload_cse_simplify_operands (insn
);
8139 /* Do a very simple CSE pass over the hard registers.
8141 This function detects no-op moves where we happened to assign two
8142 different pseudo-registers to the same hard register, and then
8143 copied one to the other. Reload will generate a useless
8144 instruction copying a register to itself.
8146 This function also detects cases where we load a value from memory
8147 into two different registers, and (if memory is more expensive than
8148 registers) changes it to simply copy the first register into the
8151 Another optimization is performed that scans the operands of each
8152 instruction to see whether the value is already available in a
8153 hard register. It then replaces the operand with the hard register
8154 if possible, much like an optional reload would. */
8157 reload_cse_regs_1 (first
)
8163 init_alias_analysis ();
8165 for (insn
= first
; insn
; insn
= NEXT_INSN (insn
))
8168 reload_cse_simplify (insn
);
8170 cselib_process_insn (insn
);
8174 end_alias_analysis ();
8178 /* Call cse / combine like post-reload optimization phases.
8179 FIRST is the first instruction. */
8181 reload_cse_regs (first
)
8184 reload_cse_regs_1 (first
);
8186 reload_cse_move2add (first
);
8187 if (flag_expensive_optimizations
)
8188 reload_cse_regs_1 (first
);
8191 /* Try to simplify a single SET instruction. SET is the set pattern.
8192 INSN is the instruction it came from.
8193 This function only handles one case: if we set a register to a value
8194 which is not a register, we try to find that value in some other register
8195 and change the set into a register copy. */
8198 reload_cse_simplify_set (set
, insn
)
8205 enum reg_class dclass
;
8208 struct elt_loc_list
*l
;
8209 #ifdef LOAD_EXTEND_OP
8210 enum rtx_code extend_op
= NIL
;
8213 dreg
= true_regnum (SET_DEST (set
));
8217 src
= SET_SRC (set
);
8218 if (side_effects_p (src
) || true_regnum (src
) >= 0)
8221 dclass
= REGNO_REG_CLASS (dreg
);
8223 #ifdef LOAD_EXTEND_OP
8224 /* When replacing a memory with a register, we need to honor assumptions
8225 that combine made wrt the contents of sign bits. We'll do this by
8226 generating an extend instruction instead of a reg->reg copy. Thus
8227 the destination must be a register that we can widen. */
8228 if (GET_CODE (src
) == MEM
8229 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (src
)) < BITS_PER_WORD
8230 && (extend_op
= LOAD_EXTEND_OP (GET_MODE (src
))) != NIL
8231 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set
)) != REG
)
8235 /* If memory loads are cheaper than register copies, don't change them. */
8236 if (GET_CODE (src
) == MEM
)
8237 old_cost
= MEMORY_MOVE_COST (GET_MODE (src
), dclass
, 1);
8238 else if (CONSTANT_P (src
))
8239 old_cost
= rtx_cost (src
, SET
);
8240 else if (GET_CODE (src
) == REG
)
8241 old_cost
= REGISTER_MOVE_COST (GET_MODE (src
),
8242 REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (src
)), dclass
);
8245 old_cost
= rtx_cost (src
, SET
);
8247 val
= cselib_lookup (src
, GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set
)), 0);
8250 for (l
= val
->locs
; l
; l
= l
->next
)
8252 rtx this_rtx
= l
->loc
;
8255 if (CONSTANT_P (this_rtx
) && ! references_value_p (this_rtx
, 0))
8257 #ifdef LOAD_EXTEND_OP
8258 if (extend_op
!= NIL
)
8260 HOST_WIDE_INT this_val
;
8262 /* ??? I'm lazy and don't wish to handle CONST_DOUBLE. Other
8263 constants, such as SYMBOL_REF, cannot be extended. */
8264 if (GET_CODE (this_rtx
) != CONST_INT
)
8267 this_val
= INTVAL (this_rtx
);
8271 this_val
&= GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (src
));
8274 /* ??? In theory we're already extended. */
8275 if (this_val
== trunc_int_for_mode (this_val
, GET_MODE (src
)))
8280 this_rtx
= GEN_INT (this_val
);
8283 this_cost
= rtx_cost (this_rtx
, SET
);
8285 else if (GET_CODE (this_rtx
) == REG
)
8287 #ifdef LOAD_EXTEND_OP
8288 if (extend_op
!= NIL
)
8290 this_rtx
= gen_rtx_fmt_e (extend_op
, word_mode
, this_rtx
);
8291 this_cost
= rtx_cost (this_rtx
, SET
);
8295 this_cost
= REGISTER_MOVE_COST (GET_MODE (this_rtx
),
8296 REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (this_rtx
)),
8302 /* If equal costs, prefer registers over anything else. That
8303 tends to lead to smaller instructions on some machines. */
8304 if (this_cost
< old_cost
8305 || (this_cost
== old_cost
8306 && GET_CODE (this_rtx
) == REG
8307 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set
)) != REG
))
8309 #ifdef LOAD_EXTEND_OP
8310 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set
))) < BITS_PER_WORD
8311 && extend_op
!= NIL
)
8313 rtx wide_dest
= gen_rtx_REG (word_mode
, REGNO (SET_DEST (set
)));
8314 ORIGINAL_REGNO (wide_dest
) = ORIGINAL_REGNO (SET_DEST (set
));
8315 validate_change (insn
, &SET_DEST (set
), wide_dest
, 1);
8319 validate_change (insn
, &SET_SRC (set
), copy_rtx (this_rtx
), 1);
8320 old_cost
= this_cost
, did_change
= 1;
8327 /* Try to replace operands in INSN with equivalent values that are already
8328 in registers. This can be viewed as optional reloading.
8330 For each non-register operand in the insn, see if any hard regs are
8331 known to be equivalent to that operand. Record the alternatives which
8332 can accept these hard registers. Among all alternatives, select the
8333 ones which are better or equal to the one currently matching, where
8334 "better" is in terms of '?' and '!' constraints. Among the remaining
8335 alternatives, select the one which replaces most operands with
8339 reload_cse_simplify_operands (insn
)
8344 /* For each operand, all registers that are equivalent to it. */
8345 HARD_REG_SET equiv_regs
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
8347 const char *constraints
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
8349 /* Vector recording how bad an alternative is. */
8350 int *alternative_reject
;
8351 /* Vector recording how many registers can be introduced by choosing
8352 this alternative. */
8353 int *alternative_nregs
;
8354 /* Array of vectors recording, for each operand and each alternative,
8355 which hard register to substitute, or -1 if the operand should be
8357 int *op_alt_regno
[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS
];
8358 /* Array of alternatives, sorted in order of decreasing desirability. */
8359 int *alternative_order
;
8360 rtx reg
= gen_rtx_REG (VOIDmode
, -1);
8362 extract_insn (insn
);
8364 if (recog_data
.n_alternatives
== 0 || recog_data
.n_operands
== 0)
8367 /* Figure out which alternative currently matches. */
8368 if (! constrain_operands (1))
8369 fatal_insn_not_found (insn
);
8371 alternative_reject
= (int *) alloca (recog_data
.n_alternatives
* sizeof (int));
8372 alternative_nregs
= (int *) alloca (recog_data
.n_alternatives
* sizeof (int));
8373 alternative_order
= (int *) alloca (recog_data
.n_alternatives
* sizeof (int));
8374 memset ((char *) alternative_reject
, 0, recog_data
.n_alternatives
* sizeof (int));
8375 memset ((char *) alternative_nregs
, 0, recog_data
.n_alternatives
* sizeof (int));
8377 /* For each operand, find out which regs are equivalent. */
8378 for (i
= 0; i
< recog_data
.n_operands
; i
++)
8381 struct elt_loc_list
*l
;
8383 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (equiv_regs
[i
]);
8385 /* cselib blows up on CODE_LABELs. Trying to fix that doesn't seem
8386 right, so avoid the problem here. Likewise if we have a constant
8387 and the insn pattern doesn't tell us the mode we need. */
8388 if (GET_CODE (recog_data
.operand
[i
]) == CODE_LABEL
8389 || (CONSTANT_P (recog_data
.operand
[i
])
8390 && recog_data
.operand_mode
[i
] == VOIDmode
))
8393 v
= cselib_lookup (recog_data
.operand
[i
], recog_data
.operand_mode
[i
], 0);
8397 for (l
= v
->locs
; l
; l
= l
->next
)
8398 if (GET_CODE (l
->loc
) == REG
)
8399 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (equiv_regs
[i
], REGNO (l
->loc
));
8402 for (i
= 0; i
< recog_data
.n_operands
; i
++)
8404 enum machine_mode mode
;
8408 op_alt_regno
[i
] = (int *) alloca (recog_data
.n_alternatives
* sizeof (int));
8409 for (j
= 0; j
< recog_data
.n_alternatives
; j
++)
8410 op_alt_regno
[i
][j
] = -1;
8412 p
= constraints
[i
] = recog_data
.constraints
[i
];
8413 mode
= recog_data
.operand_mode
[i
];
8415 /* Add the reject values for each alternative given by the constraints
8416 for this operand. */
8424 alternative_reject
[j
] += 3;
8426 alternative_reject
[j
] += 300;
8429 /* We won't change operands which are already registers. We
8430 also don't want to modify output operands. */
8431 regno
= true_regnum (recog_data
.operand
[i
]);
8433 || constraints
[i
][0] == '='
8434 || constraints
[i
][0] == '+')
8437 for (regno
= 0; regno
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; regno
++)
8439 int class = (int) NO_REGS
;
8441 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (equiv_regs
[i
], regno
))
8444 REGNO (reg
) = regno
;
8445 PUT_MODE (reg
, mode
);
8447 /* We found a register equal to this operand. Now look for all
8448 alternatives that can accept this register and have not been
8449 assigned a register they can use yet. */
8458 case '=': case '+': case '?':
8459 case '#': case '&': case '!':
8461 case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4':
8462 case '5': case '6': case '7': case '8': case '9':
8463 case 'm': case '<': case '>': case 'V': case 'o':
8464 case 'E': case 'F': case 'G': case 'H':
8465 case 's': case 'i': case 'n':
8466 case 'I': case 'J': case 'K': case 'L':
8467 case 'M': case 'N': case 'O': case 'P':
8469 /* These don't say anything we care about. */
8473 class = reg_class_subunion
[(int) class][(int) GENERAL_REGS
];
8478 = reg_class_subunion
[(int) class][(int) REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER ((unsigned char) c
)];
8481 case ',': case '\0':
8482 /* See if REGNO fits this alternative, and set it up as the
8483 replacement register if we don't have one for this
8484 alternative yet and the operand being replaced is not
8485 a cheap CONST_INT. */
8486 if (op_alt_regno
[i
][j
] == -1
8487 && reg_fits_class_p (reg
, class, 0, mode
)
8488 && (GET_CODE (recog_data
.operand
[i
]) != CONST_INT
8489 || (rtx_cost (recog_data
.operand
[i
], SET
)
8490 > rtx_cost (reg
, SET
))))
8492 alternative_nregs
[j
]++;
8493 op_alt_regno
[i
][j
] = regno
;
8505 /* Record all alternatives which are better or equal to the currently
8506 matching one in the alternative_order array. */
8507 for (i
= j
= 0; i
< recog_data
.n_alternatives
; i
++)
8508 if (alternative_reject
[i
] <= alternative_reject
[which_alternative
])
8509 alternative_order
[j
++] = i
;
8510 recog_data
.n_alternatives
= j
;
8512 /* Sort it. Given a small number of alternatives, a dumb algorithm
8513 won't hurt too much. */
8514 for (i
= 0; i
< recog_data
.n_alternatives
- 1; i
++)
8517 int best_reject
= alternative_reject
[alternative_order
[i
]];
8518 int best_nregs
= alternative_nregs
[alternative_order
[i
]];
8521 for (j
= i
+ 1; j
< recog_data
.n_alternatives
; j
++)
8523 int this_reject
= alternative_reject
[alternative_order
[j
]];
8524 int this_nregs
= alternative_nregs
[alternative_order
[j
]];
8526 if (this_reject
< best_reject
8527 || (this_reject
== best_reject
&& this_nregs
< best_nregs
))
8530 best_reject
= this_reject
;
8531 best_nregs
= this_nregs
;
8535 tmp
= alternative_order
[best
];
8536 alternative_order
[best
] = alternative_order
[i
];
8537 alternative_order
[i
] = tmp
;
8540 /* Substitute the operands as determined by op_alt_regno for the best
8542 j
= alternative_order
[0];
8544 for (i
= 0; i
< recog_data
.n_operands
; i
++)
8546 enum machine_mode mode
= recog_data
.operand_mode
[i
];
8547 if (op_alt_regno
[i
][j
] == -1)
8550 validate_change (insn
, recog_data
.operand_loc
[i
],
8551 gen_rtx_REG (mode
, op_alt_regno
[i
][j
]), 1);
8554 for (i
= recog_data
.n_dups
- 1; i
>= 0; i
--)
8556 int op
= recog_data
.dup_num
[i
];
8557 enum machine_mode mode
= recog_data
.operand_mode
[op
];
8559 if (op_alt_regno
[op
][j
] == -1)
8562 validate_change (insn
, recog_data
.dup_loc
[i
],
8563 gen_rtx_REG (mode
, op_alt_regno
[op
][j
]), 1);
8566 return apply_change_group ();
8569 /* If reload couldn't use reg+reg+offset addressing, try to use reg+reg
8571 This code might also be useful when reload gave up on reg+reg addresssing
8572 because of clashes between the return register and INDEX_REG_CLASS. */
8574 /* The maximum number of uses of a register we can keep track of to
8575 replace them with reg+reg addressing. */
8576 #define RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES 6
8578 /* INSN is the insn where a register has ben used, and USEP points to the
8579 location of the register within the rtl. */
8580 struct reg_use
{ rtx insn
, *usep
; };
8582 /* If the register is used in some unknown fashion, USE_INDEX is negative.
8583 If it is dead, USE_INDEX is RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES, and STORE_RUID
8584 indicates where it becomes live again.
8585 Otherwise, USE_INDEX is the index of the last encountered use of the
8586 register (which is first among these we have seen since we scan backwards),
8587 OFFSET contains the constant offset that is added to the register in
8588 all encountered uses, and USE_RUID indicates the first encountered, i.e.
8589 last, of these uses.
8590 STORE_RUID is always meaningful if we only want to use a value in a
8591 register in a different place: it denotes the next insn in the insn
8592 stream (i.e. the last ecountered) that sets or clobbers the register. */
8595 struct reg_use reg_use
[RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES
];
8600 } reg_state
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
8602 /* Reverse linear uid. This is increased in reload_combine while scanning
8603 the instructions from last to first. It is used to set last_label_ruid
8604 and the store_ruid / use_ruid fields in reg_state. */
8605 static int reload_combine_ruid
;
8607 #define LABEL_LIVE(LABEL) \
8608 (label_live[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (LABEL) - min_labelno])
8614 int first_index_reg
= -1;
8615 int last_index_reg
= 0;
8619 int last_label_ruid
;
8620 int min_labelno
, n_labels
;
8621 HARD_REG_SET ever_live_at_start
, *label_live
;
8623 /* If reg+reg can be used in offsetable memory addresses, the main chunk of
8624 reload has already used it where appropriate, so there is no use in
8625 trying to generate it now. */
8626 if (double_reg_address_ok
&& INDEX_REG_CLASS
!= NO_REGS
)
8629 /* To avoid wasting too much time later searching for an index register,
8630 determine the minimum and maximum index register numbers. */
8631 for (r
= 0; r
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; r
++)
8632 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents
[INDEX_REG_CLASS
], r
))
8634 if (first_index_reg
== -1)
8635 first_index_reg
= r
;
8640 /* If no index register is available, we can quit now. */
8641 if (first_index_reg
== -1)
8644 /* Set up LABEL_LIVE and EVER_LIVE_AT_START. The register lifetime
8645 information is a bit fuzzy immediately after reload, but it's
8646 still good enough to determine which registers are live at a jump
8648 min_labelno
= get_first_label_num ();
8649 n_labels
= max_label_num () - min_labelno
;
8650 label_live
= (HARD_REG_SET
*) xmalloc (n_labels
* sizeof (HARD_REG_SET
));
8651 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (ever_live_at_start
);
8653 FOR_EACH_BB_REVERSE (bb
)
8656 if (GET_CODE (insn
) == CODE_LABEL
)
8660 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (live
,
8661 bb
->global_live_at_start
);
8662 compute_use_by_pseudos (&live
,
8663 bb
->global_live_at_start
);
8664 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (LABEL_LIVE (insn
), live
);
8665 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (ever_live_at_start
, live
);
8669 /* Initialize last_label_ruid, reload_combine_ruid and reg_state. */
8670 last_label_ruid
= reload_combine_ruid
= 0;
8671 for (r
= 0; r
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; r
++)
8673 reg_state
[r
].store_ruid
= reload_combine_ruid
;
8675 reg_state
[r
].use_index
= -1;
8677 reg_state
[r
].use_index
= RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES
;
8680 for (insn
= get_last_insn (); insn
; insn
= PREV_INSN (insn
))
8684 /* We cannot do our optimization across labels. Invalidating all the use
8685 information we have would be costly, so we just note where the label
8686 is and then later disable any optimization that would cross it. */
8687 if (GET_CODE (insn
) == CODE_LABEL
)
8688 last_label_ruid
= reload_combine_ruid
;
8689 else if (GET_CODE (insn
) == BARRIER
)
8690 for (r
= 0; r
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; r
++)
8691 if (! fixed_regs
[r
])
8692 reg_state
[r
].use_index
= RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES
;
8694 if (! INSN_P (insn
))
8697 reload_combine_ruid
++;
8699 /* Look for (set (REGX) (CONST_INT))
8700 (set (REGX) (PLUS (REGX) (REGY)))
8702 ... (MEM (REGX)) ...
8704 (set (REGZ) (CONST_INT))
8706 ... (MEM (PLUS (REGZ) (REGY)))... .
8708 First, check that we have (set (REGX) (PLUS (REGX) (REGY)))
8709 and that we know all uses of REGX before it dies. */
8710 set
= single_set (insn
);
8712 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set
)) == REG
8713 && (HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO (SET_DEST (set
)),
8714 GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set
)))
8716 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set
)) == PLUS
8717 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set
), 1)) == REG
8718 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (SET_SRC (set
), 0), SET_DEST (set
))
8719 && last_label_ruid
< reg_state
[REGNO (SET_DEST (set
))].use_ruid
)
8721 rtx reg
= SET_DEST (set
);
8722 rtx plus
= SET_SRC (set
);
8723 rtx base
= XEXP (plus
, 1);
8724 rtx prev
= prev_nonnote_insn (insn
);
8725 rtx prev_set
= prev
? single_set (prev
) : NULL_RTX
;
8726 unsigned int regno
= REGNO (reg
);
8727 rtx const_reg
= NULL_RTX
;
8728 rtx reg_sum
= NULL_RTX
;
8730 /* Now, we need an index register.
8731 We'll set index_reg to this index register, const_reg to the
8732 register that is to be loaded with the constant
8733 (denoted as REGZ in the substitution illustration above),
8734 and reg_sum to the register-register that we want to use to
8735 substitute uses of REG (typically in MEMs) with.
8736 First check REG and BASE for being index registers;
8737 we can use them even if they are not dead. */
8738 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents
[INDEX_REG_CLASS
], regno
)
8739 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents
[INDEX_REG_CLASS
],
8747 /* Otherwise, look for a free index register. Since we have
8748 checked above that neiter REG nor BASE are index registers,
8749 if we find anything at all, it will be different from these
8751 for (i
= first_index_reg
; i
<= last_index_reg
; i
++)
8753 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents
[INDEX_REG_CLASS
],
8755 && reg_state
[i
].use_index
== RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES
8756 && reg_state
[i
].store_ruid
<= reg_state
[regno
].use_ruid
8757 && HARD_REGNO_NREGS (i
, GET_MODE (reg
)) == 1)
8759 rtx index_reg
= gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (reg
), i
);
8761 const_reg
= index_reg
;
8762 reg_sum
= gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (reg
), index_reg
, base
);
8768 /* Check that PREV_SET is indeed (set (REGX) (CONST_INT)) and that
8769 (REGY), i.e. BASE, is not clobbered before the last use we'll
8772 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (prev_set
)) == CONST_INT
8773 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (prev_set
), reg
)
8774 && reg_state
[regno
].use_index
>= 0
8775 && (reg_state
[REGNO (base
)].store_ruid
8776 <= reg_state
[regno
].use_ruid
)
8781 /* Change destination register and, if necessary, the
8782 constant value in PREV, the constant loading instruction. */
8783 validate_change (prev
, &SET_DEST (prev_set
), const_reg
, 1);
8784 if (reg_state
[regno
].offset
!= const0_rtx
)
8785 validate_change (prev
,
8786 &SET_SRC (prev_set
),
8787 GEN_INT (INTVAL (SET_SRC (prev_set
))
8788 + INTVAL (reg_state
[regno
].offset
)),
8791 /* Now for every use of REG that we have recorded, replace REG
8793 for (i
= reg_state
[regno
].use_index
;
8794 i
< RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES
; i
++)
8795 validate_change (reg_state
[regno
].reg_use
[i
].insn
,
8796 reg_state
[regno
].reg_use
[i
].usep
,
8797 /* Each change must have its own
8799 copy_rtx (reg_sum
), 1);
8801 if (apply_change_group ())
8805 /* Delete the reg-reg addition. */
8808 if (reg_state
[regno
].offset
!= const0_rtx
)
8809 /* Previous REG_EQUIV / REG_EQUAL notes for PREV
8811 for (np
= ®_NOTES (prev
); *np
;)
8813 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (*np
) == REG_EQUAL
8814 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*np
) == REG_EQUIV
)
8815 *np
= XEXP (*np
, 1);
8817 np
= &XEXP (*np
, 1);
8820 reg_state
[regno
].use_index
= RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES
;
8821 reg_state
[REGNO (const_reg
)].store_ruid
8822 = reload_combine_ruid
;
8828 note_stores (PATTERN (insn
), reload_combine_note_store
, NULL
);
8830 if (GET_CODE (insn
) == CALL_INSN
)
8834 for (r
= 0; r
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; r
++)
8835 if (call_used_regs
[r
])
8837 reg_state
[r
].use_index
= RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES
;
8838 reg_state
[r
].store_ruid
= reload_combine_ruid
;
8841 for (link
= CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn
); link
;
8842 link
= XEXP (link
, 1))
8844 rtx usage_rtx
= XEXP (XEXP (link
, 0), 0);
8845 if (GET_CODE (usage_rtx
) == REG
)
8848 unsigned int start_reg
= REGNO (usage_rtx
);
8849 unsigned int num_regs
=
8850 HARD_REGNO_NREGS (start_reg
, GET_MODE (usage_rtx
));
8851 unsigned int end_reg
= start_reg
+ num_regs
- 1;
8852 for (i
= start_reg
; i
<= end_reg
; i
++)
8853 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (link
, 0)) == CLOBBER
)
8855 reg_state
[i
].use_index
= RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES
;
8856 reg_state
[i
].store_ruid
= reload_combine_ruid
;
8859 reg_state
[i
].use_index
= -1;
8864 else if (GET_CODE (insn
) == JUMP_INSN
8865 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn
)) != RETURN
)
8867 /* Non-spill registers might be used at the call destination in
8868 some unknown fashion, so we have to mark the unknown use. */
8871 if ((condjump_p (insn
) || condjump_in_parallel_p (insn
))
8872 && JUMP_LABEL (insn
))
8873 live
= &LABEL_LIVE (JUMP_LABEL (insn
));
8875 live
= &ever_live_at_start
;
8877 for (i
= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
- 1; i
>= 0; --i
)
8878 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*live
, i
))
8879 reg_state
[i
].use_index
= -1;
8882 reload_combine_note_use (&PATTERN (insn
), insn
);
8883 for (note
= REG_NOTES (insn
); note
; note
= XEXP (note
, 1))
8885 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (note
) == REG_INC
8886 && GET_CODE (XEXP (note
, 0)) == REG
)
8888 int regno
= REGNO (XEXP (note
, 0));
8890 reg_state
[regno
].store_ruid
= reload_combine_ruid
;
8891 reg_state
[regno
].use_index
= -1;
8899 /* Check if DST is a register or a subreg of a register; if it is,
8900 update reg_state[regno].store_ruid and reg_state[regno].use_index
8901 accordingly. Called via note_stores from reload_combine. */
8904 reload_combine_note_store (dst
, set
, data
)
8906 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
;
8910 enum machine_mode mode
= GET_MODE (dst
);
8912 if (GET_CODE (dst
) == SUBREG
)
8914 regno
= subreg_regno_offset (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (dst
)),
8915 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (dst
)),
8918 dst
= SUBREG_REG (dst
);
8920 if (GET_CODE (dst
) != REG
)
8922 regno
+= REGNO (dst
);
8924 /* note_stores might have stripped a STRICT_LOW_PART, so we have to be
8925 careful with registers / register parts that are not full words.
8927 Similarly for ZERO_EXTRACT and SIGN_EXTRACT. */
8928 if (GET_CODE (set
) != SET
8929 || GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set
)) == ZERO_EXTRACT
8930 || GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set
)) == SIGN_EXTRACT
8931 || GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set
)) == STRICT_LOW_PART
)
8933 for (i
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno
, mode
) - 1 + regno
; i
>= regno
; i
--)
8935 reg_state
[i
].use_index
= -1;
8936 reg_state
[i
].store_ruid
= reload_combine_ruid
;
8941 for (i
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno
, mode
) - 1 + regno
; i
>= regno
; i
--)
8943 reg_state
[i
].store_ruid
= reload_combine_ruid
;
8944 reg_state
[i
].use_index
= RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES
;
8949 /* XP points to a piece of rtl that has to be checked for any uses of
8951 *XP is the pattern of INSN, or a part of it.
8952 Called from reload_combine, and recursively by itself. */
8954 reload_combine_note_use (xp
, insn
)
8958 enum rtx_code code
= x
->code
;
8961 rtx offset
= const0_rtx
; /* For the REG case below. */
8966 if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x
)) == REG
)
8968 reload_combine_note_use (&SET_SRC (x
), insn
);
8974 /* If this is the USE of a return value, we can't change it. */
8975 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x
, 0)) == REG
&& REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (XEXP (x
, 0)))
8977 /* Mark the return register as used in an unknown fashion. */
8978 rtx reg
= XEXP (x
, 0);
8979 int regno
= REGNO (reg
);
8980 int nregs
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno
, GET_MODE (reg
));
8982 while (--nregs
>= 0)
8983 reg_state
[regno
+ nregs
].use_index
= -1;
8989 if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x
)) == REG
)
8991 /* No spurious CLOBBERs of pseudo registers may remain. */
8992 if (REGNO (SET_DEST (x
)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
8999 /* We are interested in (plus (reg) (const_int)) . */
9000 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x
, 0)) != REG
9001 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x
, 1)) != CONST_INT
)
9003 offset
= XEXP (x
, 1);
9008 int regno
= REGNO (x
);
9012 /* No spurious USEs of pseudo registers may remain. */
9013 if (regno
>= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
9016 nregs
= HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno
, GET_MODE (x
));
9018 /* We can't substitute into multi-hard-reg uses. */
9021 while (--nregs
>= 0)
9022 reg_state
[regno
+ nregs
].use_index
= -1;
9026 /* If this register is already used in some unknown fashion, we
9028 If we decrement the index from zero to -1, we can't store more
9029 uses, so this register becomes used in an unknown fashion. */
9030 use_index
= --reg_state
[regno
].use_index
;
9034 if (use_index
!= RELOAD_COMBINE_MAX_USES
- 1)
9036 /* We have found another use for a register that is already
9037 used later. Check if the offsets match; if not, mark the
9038 register as used in an unknown fashion. */
9039 if (! rtx_equal_p (offset
, reg_state
[regno
].offset
))
9041 reg_state
[regno
].use_index
= -1;
9047 /* This is the first use of this register we have seen since we
9048 marked it as dead. */
9049 reg_state
[regno
].offset
= offset
;
9050 reg_state
[regno
].use_ruid
= reload_combine_ruid
;
9052 reg_state
[regno
].reg_use
[use_index
].insn
= insn
;
9053 reg_state
[regno
].reg_use
[use_index
].usep
= xp
;
9061 /* Recursively process the components of X. */
9062 fmt
= GET_RTX_FORMAT (code
);
9063 for (i
= GET_RTX_LENGTH (code
) - 1; i
>= 0; i
--)
9066 reload_combine_note_use (&XEXP (x
, i
), insn
);
9067 else if (fmt
[i
] == 'E')
9069 for (j
= XVECLEN (x
, i
) - 1; j
>= 0; j
--)
9070 reload_combine_note_use (&XVECEXP (x
, i
, j
), insn
);
9075 /* See if we can reduce the cost of a constant by replacing a move
9076 with an add. We track situations in which a register is set to a
9077 constant or to a register plus a constant. */
9078 /* We cannot do our optimization across labels. Invalidating all the
9079 information about register contents we have would be costly, so we
9080 use move2add_last_label_luid to note where the label is and then
9081 later disable any optimization that would cross it.
9082 reg_offset[n] / reg_base_reg[n] / reg_mode[n] are only valid if
9083 reg_set_luid[n] is greater than last_label_luid[n] . */
9084 static int reg_set_luid
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
9086 /* If reg_base_reg[n] is negative, register n has been set to
9087 reg_offset[n] in mode reg_mode[n] .
9088 If reg_base_reg[n] is non-negative, register n has been set to the
9089 sum of reg_offset[n] and the value of register reg_base_reg[n]
9090 before reg_set_luid[n], calculated in mode reg_mode[n] . */
9091 static HOST_WIDE_INT reg_offset
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
9092 static int reg_base_reg
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
9093 static enum machine_mode reg_mode
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
9095 /* move2add_luid is linearily increased while scanning the instructions
9096 from first to last. It is used to set reg_set_luid in
9097 reload_cse_move2add and move2add_note_store. */
9098 static int move2add_luid
;
9100 /* move2add_last_label_luid is set whenever a label is found. Labels
9101 invalidate all previously collected reg_offset data. */
9102 static int move2add_last_label_luid
;
9104 /* Generate a CONST_INT and force it in the range of MODE. */
9106 static HOST_WIDE_INT
9107 sext_for_mode (mode
, value
)
9108 enum machine_mode mode
;
9109 HOST_WIDE_INT value
;
9111 HOST_WIDE_INT cval
= value
& GET_MODE_MASK (mode
);
9112 int width
= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode
);
9114 /* If MODE is narrower than HOST_WIDE_INT and CVAL is a negative number,
9116 if (width
> 0 && width
< HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
9117 && (cval
& ((HOST_WIDE_INT
) 1 << (width
- 1))) != 0)
9118 cval
|= (HOST_WIDE_INT
) -1 << width
;
9123 /* ??? We don't know how zero / sign extension is handled, hence we
9124 can't go from a narrower to a wider mode. */
9125 #define MODES_OK_FOR_MOVE2ADD(OUTMODE, INMODE) \
9126 (GET_MODE_SIZE (OUTMODE) == GET_MODE_SIZE (INMODE) \
9127 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (OUTMODE) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (INMODE) \
9128 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (OUTMODE), \
9129 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (INMODE))))
9132 reload_cse_move2add (first
)
9138 for (i
= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
- 1; i
>= 0; i
--)
9139 reg_set_luid
[i
] = 0;
9141 move2add_last_label_luid
= 0;
9143 for (insn
= first
; insn
; insn
= NEXT_INSN (insn
), move2add_luid
++)
9147 if (GET_CODE (insn
) == CODE_LABEL
)
9149 move2add_last_label_luid
= move2add_luid
;
9150 /* We're going to increment move2add_luid twice after a
9151 label, so that we can use move2add_last_label_luid + 1 as
9152 the luid for constants. */
9156 if (! INSN_P (insn
))
9158 pat
= PATTERN (insn
);
9159 /* For simplicity, we only perform this optimization on
9160 straightforward SETs. */
9161 if (GET_CODE (pat
) == SET
9162 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (pat
)) == REG
)
9164 rtx reg
= SET_DEST (pat
);
9165 int regno
= REGNO (reg
);
9166 rtx src
= SET_SRC (pat
);
9168 /* Check if we have valid information on the contents of this
9169 register in the mode of REG. */
9170 if (reg_set_luid
[regno
] > move2add_last_label_luid
9171 && MODES_OK_FOR_MOVE2ADD (GET_MODE (reg
), reg_mode
[regno
]))
9173 /* Try to transform (set (REGX) (CONST_INT A))
9175 (set (REGX) (CONST_INT B))
9177 (set (REGX) (CONST_INT A))
9179 (set (REGX) (plus (REGX) (CONST_INT B-A))) */
9181 if (GET_CODE (src
) == CONST_INT
&& reg_base_reg
[regno
] < 0)
9184 rtx new_src
= GEN_INT (sext_for_mode (GET_MODE (reg
),
9186 - reg_offset
[regno
]));
9187 /* (set (reg) (plus (reg) (const_int 0))) is not canonical;
9188 use (set (reg) (reg)) instead.
9189 We don't delete this insn, nor do we convert it into a
9190 note, to avoid losing register notes or the return
9191 value flag. jump2 already knowns how to get rid of
9193 if (new_src
== const0_rtx
)
9194 success
= validate_change (insn
, &SET_SRC (pat
), reg
, 0);
9195 else if (rtx_cost (new_src
, PLUS
) < rtx_cost (src
, SET
)
9196 && have_add2_insn (reg
, new_src
))
9197 success
= validate_change (insn
, &PATTERN (insn
),
9198 gen_add2_insn (reg
, new_src
), 0);
9199 reg_set_luid
[regno
] = move2add_luid
;
9200 reg_mode
[regno
] = GET_MODE (reg
);
9201 reg_offset
[regno
] = INTVAL (src
);
9205 /* Try to transform (set (REGX) (REGY))
9206 (set (REGX) (PLUS (REGX) (CONST_INT A)))
9209 (set (REGX) (PLUS (REGX) (CONST_INT B)))
9212 (set (REGX) (PLUS (REGX) (CONST_INT A)))
9214 (set (REGX) (plus (REGX) (CONST_INT B-A))) */
9215 else if (GET_CODE (src
) == REG
9216 && reg_set_luid
[regno
] == reg_set_luid
[REGNO (src
)]
9217 && reg_base_reg
[regno
] == reg_base_reg
[REGNO (src
)]
9218 && MODES_OK_FOR_MOVE2ADD (GET_MODE (reg
),
9219 reg_mode
[REGNO (src
)]))
9221 rtx next
= next_nonnote_insn (insn
);
9224 set
= single_set (next
);
9226 && SET_DEST (set
) == reg
9227 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set
)) == PLUS
9228 && XEXP (SET_SRC (set
), 0) == reg
9229 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set
), 1)) == CONST_INT
)
9231 rtx src3
= XEXP (SET_SRC (set
), 1);
9232 HOST_WIDE_INT added_offset
= INTVAL (src3
);
9233 HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset
= reg_offset
[REGNO (src
)];
9234 HOST_WIDE_INT regno_offset
= reg_offset
[regno
];
9235 rtx new_src
= GEN_INT (sext_for_mode (GET_MODE (reg
),
9241 if (new_src
== const0_rtx
)
9242 /* See above why we create (set (reg) (reg)) here. */
9244 = validate_change (next
, &SET_SRC (set
), reg
, 0);
9245 else if ((rtx_cost (new_src
, PLUS
)
9246 < COSTS_N_INSNS (1) + rtx_cost (src3
, SET
))
9247 && have_add2_insn (reg
, new_src
))
9249 = validate_change (next
, &PATTERN (next
),
9250 gen_add2_insn (reg
, new_src
), 0);
9254 reg_mode
[regno
] = GET_MODE (reg
);
9255 reg_offset
[regno
] = sext_for_mode (GET_MODE (reg
),
9264 for (note
= REG_NOTES (insn
); note
; note
= XEXP (note
, 1))
9266 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (note
) == REG_INC
9267 && GET_CODE (XEXP (note
, 0)) == REG
)
9269 /* Reset the information about this register. */
9270 int regno
= REGNO (XEXP (note
, 0));
9271 if (regno
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
9272 reg_set_luid
[regno
] = 0;
9275 note_stores (PATTERN (insn
), move2add_note_store
, NULL
);
9276 /* If this is a CALL_INSN, all call used registers are stored with
9278 if (GET_CODE (insn
) == CALL_INSN
)
9280 for (i
= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
- 1; i
>= 0; i
--)
9282 if (call_used_regs
[i
])
9283 /* Reset the information about this register. */
9284 reg_set_luid
[i
] = 0;
9290 /* SET is a SET or CLOBBER that sets DST.
9291 Update reg_set_luid, reg_offset and reg_base_reg accordingly.
9292 Called from reload_cse_move2add via note_stores. */
9295 move2add_note_store (dst
, set
, data
)
9297 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
;
9299 unsigned int regno
= 0;
9301 enum machine_mode mode
= GET_MODE (dst
);
9303 if (GET_CODE (dst
) == SUBREG
)
9305 regno
= subreg_regno_offset (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (dst
)),
9306 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (dst
)),
9309 dst
= SUBREG_REG (dst
);
9312 /* Some targets do argument pushes without adding REG_INC notes. */
9314 if (GET_CODE (dst
) == MEM
)
9316 dst
= XEXP (dst
, 0);
9317 if (GET_CODE (dst
) == PRE_INC
|| GET_CODE (dst
) == POST_INC
9318 || GET_CODE (dst
) == PRE_DEC
|| GET_CODE (dst
) == POST_DEC
)
9319 reg_set_luid
[REGNO (XEXP (dst
, 0))] = 0;
9322 if (GET_CODE (dst
) != REG
)
9325 regno
+= REGNO (dst
);
9327 if (HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno
, mode
) == 1 && GET_CODE (set
) == SET
9328 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set
)) != ZERO_EXTRACT
9329 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set
)) != SIGN_EXTRACT
9330 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set
)) != STRICT_LOW_PART
)
9332 rtx src
= SET_SRC (set
);
9334 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
;
9336 /* This may be different from mode, if SET_DEST (set) is a
9338 enum machine_mode dst_mode
= GET_MODE (dst
);
9340 switch (GET_CODE (src
))
9343 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src
, 0)) == REG
)
9345 base_reg
= XEXP (src
, 0);
9347 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src
, 1)) == CONST_INT
)
9348 offset
= INTVAL (XEXP (src
, 1));
9349 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src
, 1)) == REG
9350 && (reg_set_luid
[REGNO (XEXP (src
, 1))]
9351 > move2add_last_label_luid
)
9352 && (MODES_OK_FOR_MOVE2ADD
9353 (dst_mode
, reg_mode
[REGNO (XEXP (src
, 1))])))
9355 if (reg_base_reg
[REGNO (XEXP (src
, 1))] < 0)
9356 offset
= reg_offset
[REGNO (XEXP (src
, 1))];
9357 /* Maybe the first register is known to be a
9359 else if (reg_set_luid
[REGNO (base_reg
)]
9360 > move2add_last_label_luid
9361 && (MODES_OK_FOR_MOVE2ADD
9362 (dst_mode
, reg_mode
[REGNO (XEXP (src
, 1))]))
9363 && reg_base_reg
[REGNO (base_reg
)] < 0)
9365 offset
= reg_offset
[REGNO (base_reg
)];
9366 base_reg
= XEXP (src
, 1);
9385 /* Start tracking the register as a constant. */
9386 reg_base_reg
[regno
] = -1;
9387 reg_offset
[regno
] = INTVAL (SET_SRC (set
));
9388 /* We assign the same luid to all registers set to constants. */
9389 reg_set_luid
[regno
] = move2add_last_label_luid
+ 1;
9390 reg_mode
[regno
] = mode
;
9395 /* Invalidate the contents of the register. */
9396 reg_set_luid
[regno
] = 0;
9400 base_regno
= REGNO (base_reg
);
9401 /* If information about the base register is not valid, set it
9402 up as a new base register, pretending its value is known
9403 starting from the current insn. */
9404 if (reg_set_luid
[base_regno
] <= move2add_last_label_luid
)
9406 reg_base_reg
[base_regno
] = base_regno
;
9407 reg_offset
[base_regno
] = 0;
9408 reg_set_luid
[base_regno
] = move2add_luid
;
9409 reg_mode
[base_regno
] = mode
;
9411 else if (! MODES_OK_FOR_MOVE2ADD (dst_mode
,
9412 reg_mode
[base_regno
]))
9415 reg_mode
[regno
] = mode
;
9417 /* Copy base information from our base register. */
9418 reg_set_luid
[regno
] = reg_set_luid
[base_regno
];
9419 reg_base_reg
[regno
] = reg_base_reg
[base_regno
];
9421 /* Compute the sum of the offsets or constants. */
9422 reg_offset
[regno
] = sext_for_mode (dst_mode
,
9424 + reg_offset
[base_regno
]);
9428 unsigned int endregno
= regno
+ HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno
, mode
);
9430 for (i
= regno
; i
< endregno
; i
++)
9431 /* Reset the information about this register. */
9432 reg_set_luid
[i
] = 0;
9438 add_auto_inc_notes (insn
, x
)
9442 enum rtx_code code
= GET_CODE (x
);
9446 if (code
== MEM
&& auto_inc_p (XEXP (x
, 0)))
9449 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_INC
, XEXP (XEXP (x
, 0), 0), REG_NOTES (insn
));
9453 /* Scan all the operand sub-expressions. */
9454 fmt
= GET_RTX_FORMAT (code
);
9455 for (i
= GET_RTX_LENGTH (code
) - 1; i
>= 0; i
--)
9458 add_auto_inc_notes (insn
, XEXP (x
, i
));
9459 else if (fmt
[i
] == 'E')
9460 for (j
= XVECLEN (x
, i
) - 1; j
>= 0; j
--)
9461 add_auto_inc_notes (insn
, XVECEXP (x
, i
, j
));
9466 /* Copy EH notes from an insn to its reloads. */
9468 copy_eh_notes (insn
, x
)
9472 rtx eh_note
= find_reg_note (insn
, REG_EH_REGION
, NULL_RTX
);
9475 for (; x
!= 0; x
= NEXT_INSN (x
))
9477 if (may_trap_p (PATTERN (x
)))
9479 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EH_REGION
, XEXP (eh_note
, 0),
9485 /* This is used by reload pass, that does emit some instructions after
9486 abnormal calls moving basic block end, but in fact it wants to emit
9487 them on the edge. Looks for abnormal call edges, find backward the
9488 proper call and fix the damage.
9490 Similar handle instructions throwing exceptions internally. */
9492 fixup_abnormal_edges ()
9494 bool inserted
= false;
9501 /* Look for cases we are interested in - an calls or instructions causing
9503 for (e
= bb
->succ
; e
; e
= e
->succ_next
)
9505 if (e
->flags
& EDGE_ABNORMAL_CALL
)
9507 if ((e
->flags
& (EDGE_ABNORMAL
| EDGE_EH
))
9508 == (EDGE_ABNORMAL
| EDGE_EH
))
9511 if (e
&& GET_CODE (bb
->end
) != CALL_INSN
&& !can_throw_internal (bb
->end
))
9513 rtx insn
= bb
->end
, stop
= NEXT_INSN (bb
->end
);
9515 for (e
= bb
->succ
; e
; e
= e
->succ_next
)
9516 if (e
->flags
& EDGE_FALLTHRU
)
9518 /* Get past the new insns generated. Allow notes, as the insns may
9519 be already deleted. */
9520 while ((GET_CODE (insn
) == INSN
|| GET_CODE (insn
) == NOTE
)
9521 && !can_throw_internal (insn
)
9522 && insn
!= bb
->head
)
9523 insn
= PREV_INSN (insn
);
9524 if (GET_CODE (insn
) != CALL_INSN
&& !can_throw_internal (insn
))
9528 insn
= NEXT_INSN (insn
);
9529 while (insn
&& insn
!= stop
)
9531 next
= NEXT_INSN (insn
);
9538 /* We're not deleting it, we're moving it. */
9539 INSN_DELETED_P (insn
) = 0;
9541 /* Emit a sequence, rather than scarfing the pattern, so
9542 that we don't lose REG_NOTES etc. */
9543 /* ??? Could copy the test from gen_sequence, but don't
9544 think it's worth the bother. */
9545 seq
= gen_rtx_SEQUENCE (VOIDmode
, gen_rtvec (1, insn
));
9546 insert_insn_on_edge (seq
, e
);
9553 commit_edge_insertions ();